[gdb/symtab] Fix line-table end-of-sequence sorting
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
b3adc24a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
b3adc24a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
b3adc24a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129@ifset GENERIC
130* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
131@end ifset
132@ifclear GENERIC
133@ifset H8300
134* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
135@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
136@ifset Renesas
137* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 138@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
139@ifset ARM
140* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
141@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
142@ifset M68HC11
143* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
144@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
145@ifset HPPA
146* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
147@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
148@ifset M68K
149* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
150@end ifset
833794fc
MR
151@ifset MIPS
152* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
153@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
154@ifset POWERPC
155* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
156@end ifset
157@ifset POWERPC64
158* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
159@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
160@ifset S/390
161* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
162@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
163@ifset SPU
164* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
165@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
166@ifset TICOFF
167* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
168@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
169@ifset WIN32
170* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
171@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
172@ifset XTENSA
173* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
174@end ifset
252b5132
RH
175@end ifclear
176@ifclear SingleFormat
177* BFD:: BFD
178@end ifclear
179@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
180
181* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
182* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 183* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 184* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 185@end menu
84ec0e6d 186@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
187
188@node Overview
189@chapter Overview
190
191@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
192@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 193
0879a67a 194@ifset man
0285c67d 195@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 196ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
197@c man end
198
199@c man begin SEEALSO
200ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
201the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
202@file{ld}.
203@c man end
204@end ifset
205
206@c man begin DESCRIPTION
207
ff5dcc92 208@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 209their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 210compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 211
ff5dcc92 212@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
213a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
214to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
215
0285c67d
NC
216@ifset man
217@c For the man only
ece2d90e 218This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
219@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
220language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
221@end ifset
222
252b5132 223@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
224This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
225to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
226write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
227@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
228available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
229@end ifclear
230
231Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
232linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
233execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 234@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
235(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
236
0285c67d
NC
237@c man end
238
252b5132
RH
239@node Invocation
240@chapter Invocation
241
0285c67d
NC
242@c man begin DESCRIPTION
243
ff5dcc92 244The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
245and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
246you have many choices to control its behavior.
247
0285c67d
NC
248@c man end
249
252b5132
RH
250@ifset UsesEnvVars
251@menu
a05a5b64 252* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
253* Environment:: Environment Variables
254@end menu
255
256@node Options
a05a5b64 257@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
258@end ifset
259
260@cindex command line
261@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
262
263@c man begin OPTIONS
264
252b5132
RH
265The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
266practice few of them are used in any particular context.
267@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 268For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
269object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
270link a file @code{hello.o}:
271
272@smallexample
273ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
274@end smallexample
275
ff5dcc92 276This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
277result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
278the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
279directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
280
ff5dcc92 281Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
282point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
283as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
284which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
285files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
286different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
287occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
288option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
289noted in the descriptions below.
290
291@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
292Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
293together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
294options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
295an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
296
297Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
298specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
299and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
300are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
301message @samp{No input files}.
302
36f63dca 303If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
304assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
305augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
306linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
307permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
308or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
309@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
310script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
311extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
312to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
313the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
314
315For options whose names are a single letter,
316option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
317whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
318option that requires them.
319
320For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 321precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 322@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 323this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 324only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
325@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
326name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
327output.
328
329Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
330option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
331immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
332@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
333Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
334accepted.
252b5132 335
36f63dca 336Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 337(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
338prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
339compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
340
341@smallexample
2509a395 342 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
343@end smallexample
344
345This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
346silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
347may also arise when passing options that require values through a
348driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
349a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
350and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
351the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
352
353@smallexample
354 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
355@end smallexample
4e53152f 356
a05a5b64 357Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
358linker:
359
ff5dcc92 360@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 361@include at-file.texi
dff70155 362
2509a395
SL
363@kindex -a @var{keyword}
364@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
365This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
366argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
367@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
368@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
369to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
370
7ee314fa
AM
371@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
372@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
374@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
375specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
376will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
377finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 378it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 379This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 380interface.
7ee314fa 381
252b5132
RH
382@ifclear SingleFormat
383@cindex binary input format
384@kindex -b @var{format}
385@kindex --format=@var{format}
386@cindex input format
387@cindex input format
388@item -b @var{input-format}
389@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
390@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
391file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 392@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 393that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 394configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 395to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
396default input format the most usual format on each machine.
397@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
398supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
399formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
400@xref{BFD}.
401
402You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
403binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
404linking object files of different formats), by including
405@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 406particular format.
252b5132
RH
407
408The default format is taken from the environment variable
409@code{GNUTARGET}.
410@ifset UsesEnvVars
411@xref{Environment}.
412@end ifset
413You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
414@code{TARGET};
415@ifclear man
416see @ref{Format Commands}.
417@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
418@end ifclear
419
420@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
421@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@cindex compatibility, MRI
423@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
424@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 425For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 426files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
427@ifclear man
428@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
429@end ifclear
430@ifset man
431the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
432@end ifset
433Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 434the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
435scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
436If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
437specified by any @samp{-L} options.
438
439@cindex common allocation
440@kindex -d
441@kindex -dc
442@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 443@item -d
252b5132
RH
444@itemx -dc
445@itemx -dp
446These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
447compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
448even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
449script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
450@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
451
7ee314fa
AM
452@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
453@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
454@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
455@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
456Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
457@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
458specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
459will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
460option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 461The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 462
abf874aa
CL
463@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
464@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
466fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
467section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
468error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
469several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
470section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
471sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
472
473@smallexample
474 MEMORY @{
475 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
476 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
477 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 @}
479 SECTIONS @{
480 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
481 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
482 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 @}
484
485 with input sections:
486 .data.1: size 8
487 .data.2: size 0x10
488 .data.3: size 4
489
490 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
491 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
492@end smallexample
493
494This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
495the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
496
497@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
498@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499This option enables warnings when
500@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
501matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
502discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
503output region.
504
252b5132
RH
505@cindex entry point, from command line
506@kindex -e @var{entry}
507@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 508@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
509@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
510Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
511program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
512named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
513and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
514base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
515@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
516and other ways of specifying the entry point.
517
b58f81ae
DJ
518@kindex --exclude-libs
519@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
520Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 521exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
522@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
523automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
524port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
525explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
526option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
527be treated as hidden.
528
e1c37eb5
DK
529@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
530@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
531Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
532should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
533into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
534may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
535used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
536the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
537match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
538command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
539of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
540regardless of this option.
541
252b5132
RH
542@cindex dynamic symbol table
543@kindex -E
544@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 545@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
546@item -E
547@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
548@itemx --no-export-dynamic
549When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
550option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
551all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
552set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
553
554If you do not use either of these options (or use the
555@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
556dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
557referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
558
559If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
560back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
561dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
562linking the program itself.
563
55255dae 564You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 565be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 566See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 567
8b747e1a
DK
568Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
569support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
570the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
571
37a141bf
FS
572@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
573@cindex export dynamic symbol
574@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
575When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
576@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
577shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
578bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
579no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
580@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
581on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
582
583@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
584@cindex export dynamic symbol list
585@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
586Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
587The format of the file is the same as the version node without
588scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
589
36f63dca 590@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
591@cindex big-endian objects
592@cindex endianness
593@kindex -EB
594@item -EB
595Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
596
597@cindex little-endian objects
598@kindex -EL
599@item -EL
600Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 601@end ifclear
252b5132 602
2509a395
SL
603@kindex -f @var{name}
604@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
605@item -f @var{name}
606@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
607When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
608to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
609table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
610symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
611
612If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
613run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
614the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
615first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
616@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
617in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
618Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
619implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 620machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
621
622This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
623will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
624
2509a395
SL
625@kindex -F @var{name}
626@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 627@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 628@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
629When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
630the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
631of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
632on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
633
634If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
635run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
636dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
637filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
638found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
639used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
640@var{name}.
641
ff5dcc92 642Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 643toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
644object files.
645@ifclear SingleFormat
646The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 647@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 648@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
649environment variable.
650@end ifclear
651The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
652creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 653
3dbf70a2 654@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
655@kindex -fini=@var{name}
656@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
657When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
658executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
659address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
660the function to call.
661
252b5132
RH
662@kindex -g
663@item -g
664Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
665
2509a395
SL
666@kindex -G @var{value}
667@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 668@cindex object size
2509a395 669@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
670@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
671Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
672@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 673MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
674sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
675
676@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 677@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 678@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 679@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
680@itemx -soname=@var{name}
681When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
682the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
683which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
684linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
685field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
686
687@kindex -i
688@cindex incremental link
689@item -i
690Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
691
3dbf70a2 692@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
693@kindex -init=@var{name}
694@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
695When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
696executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
697of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
698function to call.
699
252b5132 700@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 701@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 702@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 703@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
704@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
705Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
706list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
707If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 708will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 709will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 710
ff5dcc92 711On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
712files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
713and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
714called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
715@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
716indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
717to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
718@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
719
720The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
721specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
722was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
723command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
724archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
725the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
726
ff5dcc92 727See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
728archives multiple times.
729
730You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
731
732@ifset GENERIC
733This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 734if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
735behaviour of the AIX linker.
736@end ifset
737
738@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 739@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 740@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 741@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 742@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
743Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
744for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
745option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
746in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
747on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 748@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
749order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
750how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
751option is specified.
252b5132 752
3aa2d05a
NC
753If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
754prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
755@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 756
252b5132
RH
757@ifset UsesEnvVars
758The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 759@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
760some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
761@end ifset
762
763The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
764@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
765at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
766
767@cindex emulation
768@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 769@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
770Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
771emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
772
773If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
774@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
775
776Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
777configured.
778
779@cindex link map
780@kindex -M
781@kindex --print-map
782@item -M
783@itemx --print-map
784Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
785information about the link, including the following:
786
787@itemize @bullet
788@item
3b83e13a 789Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
790@item
791How common symbols are allocated.
792@item
793All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
794which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
795@item
796The values assigned to symbols.
797
798Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
799involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
800have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
801linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
802of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
803the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
804linker script containing:
805
806@smallexample
807 foo = 1
808 foo = foo * 4
809 foo = foo + 8
810@end smallexample
811
812will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
813option is used:
814
815@smallexample
816 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
817 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
819@end smallexample
820
821See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
822scripts.
d2ef37eb 823
06ddcada
AM
824@item
825How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 826
06ddcada
AM
827When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
828.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
829These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
830
831@smallexample
832Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
833@end smallexample
834
06ddcada 835This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
836merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
837is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
838
839@smallexample
06ddcada 840Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
841@end smallexample
842
06ddcada 843This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
844when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
845is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
846@end itemize
847
035801ce
FS
848@cindex link map discarded
849@kindex --print-map-discarded
850@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
851@item --print-map-discarded
852@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
853Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
854in the link map. Enabled by default.
855
252b5132
RH
856@kindex -n
857@cindex read-only text
858@cindex NMAGIC
859@kindex --nmagic
860@item -n
861@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
862Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
863libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
864mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
865
866@kindex -N
867@kindex --omagic
868@cindex read/write from cmd line
869@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 870@item -N
252b5132
RH
871@itemx --omagic
872Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
873not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
874libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
875mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
876is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
877specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
878
879@kindex --no-omagic
880@cindex OMAGIC
881@item --no-omagic
882This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
883sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
884be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
885shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
886
887@kindex -o @var{output}
888@kindex --output=@var{output}
889@cindex naming the output file
890@item -o @var{output}
891@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 892Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
893option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
894script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
895
f37b21b4
RM
896@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
897@cindex dependency file
898@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
899Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
900suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
901that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
902output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
903Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
904Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
905to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
906linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
907@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
908installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
909distributed makefiles without careful editing.
910
252b5132
RH
911@kindex -O @var{level}
912@cindex generating optimized output
913@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 914If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 915the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
916should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
917option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
918the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
919no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
920of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 921
387dd777
DP
922@kindex -plugin @var{name}
923@item -plugin @var{name}
924Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
925the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
926automatically added by the complier, when using link time
927optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
928wish.
929
930Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
931from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
932@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
933those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 934copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 935based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 936just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 937
26278bb8
UD
938@kindex --push-state
939@cindex push state governing input file handling
940@item --push-state
941The @option{--push-state} allows to preserve the current state of the
942flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
943restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
944
945The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
946@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
947@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
948@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
949@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
950@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
951
952One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
953used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
954listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
955something as follows:
956
957@smallexample
958-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
959@end smallexample
960
961@kindex --pop-state
962@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 963@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
964Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
965flags governing input file handling.
966
a712da20
NC
967@kindex -q
968@kindex --emit-relocs
969@cindex retain relocations in final executable
970@item -q
971@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 972Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
973Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
974order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
975in larger executables.
976
dbab7a7b
NC
977This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
978
4f471f39
RS
979@kindex --force-dynamic
980@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
981@item --force-dynamic
982Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
983to VxWorks targets.
984
252b5132
RH
985@cindex partial link
986@cindex relocatable output
987@kindex -r
1049f94e 988@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 989@item -r
1049f94e 990@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 991Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 992turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
993linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
994magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
995@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 996@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
997If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
998linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
999constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1000
62bf86b4
HPN
1001When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1002partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1003relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1004example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1005with input files in other formats at all.
1006
252b5132
RH
1007This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1008
1009@kindex -R @var{file}
1010@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1011@cindex symbol-only input
1012@item -R @var{filename}
1013@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1014Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1015relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1016to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1017programs. You may use this option more than once.
1018
ff5dcc92 1019For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1020followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1021the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1022
1023@kindex -s
1024@kindex --strip-all
1025@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1026@item -s
252b5132
RH
1027@itemx --strip-all
1028Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1029
1030@kindex -S
1031@kindex --strip-debug
1032@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1033@item -S
252b5132
RH
1034@itemx --strip-debug
1035Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1036
a70f34c0
NC
1037@kindex --strip-discarded
1038@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1039@item --strip-discarded
1040@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1041Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1042Enabled by default.
1043
252b5132
RH
1044@kindex -t
1045@kindex --trace
1046@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1047@item -t
252b5132 1048@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1049Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1050@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1051@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1052and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1053a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1054
1055@kindex -T @var{script}
1056@kindex --script=@var{script}
1057@cindex script files
1058@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1059@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1060Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1061@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1062@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1063output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1064the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1065specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1066options accumulate.
252b5132 1067
14be8564
L
1068@kindex -dT @var{script}
1069@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1070@cindex script files
1071@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1072@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1073Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1074
1075This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1076processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1077command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1078@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1079behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1080command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1081the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1082@samp{gcc}).
1083
252b5132
RH
1084@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1085@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1086@cindex undefined symbol
1087@item -u @var{symbol}
1088@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1089Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1090symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1091modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1092different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1093option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1094
0a618243
AB
1095If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1096into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1097undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1098instead.
1099
1100@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1101@cindex symbols, require defined
1102@cindex defined symbol
1103@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1104Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1105is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1106is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1107and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1108@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1109can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1110
252b5132
RH
1111@kindex -Ur
1112@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1113@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1114For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1115@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1116turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1117@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1118It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1119with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1120be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1121@samp{-r} for the others.
1122
c005eb9e
AB
1123@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1124@cindex orphan sections
1125@cindex sections, orphan
1126@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1127Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1128specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1129
1130@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1131
1132@table @code
1133@item place
1134Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1135the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1136@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1137
1138@item discard
1139All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1140@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1141
1142@item warn
1143The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1144issue a warning.
1145
1146@item error
1147The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1148@end table
1149
1150The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1151
577a0623
AM
1152@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1153@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1155@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1156missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1157specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1158multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1159input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1160in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1161
252b5132
RH
1162@kindex -v
1163@kindex -V
1164@kindex --version
1165@cindex version
1166@item -v
1167@itemx --version
1168@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1169Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1170lists the supported emulations.
1171
1172@kindex -x
1173@kindex --discard-all
1174@cindex deleting local symbols
1175@item -x
1176@itemx --discard-all
1177Delete all local symbols.
1178
1179@kindex -X
1180@kindex --discard-locals
1181@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1182@item -X
252b5132 1183@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1184Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1185system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1186or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1187
1188@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1189@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1190@cindex symbol tracing
1191@item -y @var{symbol}
1192@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1193Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1194option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1195to prepend an underscore.
1196
1197This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1198don't know where the reference is coming from.
1199
1200@kindex -Y @var{path}
1201@item -Y @var{path}
1202Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1203for Solaris compatibility.
1204
1205@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1206@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1207The recognized keywords are:
1208@table @samp
1209
e6e2dfbd
AM
1210@item bndplt
1211Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1212
1213@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1214@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1215@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1216@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1217Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1218to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1219@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1220@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1221@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1222@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1223Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1224
233a0083
L
1225@item cet-report=none
1226@itemx cet-report=warning
1227@itemx cet-report=error
1228Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1229GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1230section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1231linker not report missing properties in input files.
1232@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1233missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1234the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1235Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1236GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1237turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1238Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1239
cd6d6c15 1240@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1241@itemx nocombreloc
1242Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1243dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1244
b8871f35 1245@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1246@itemx nocommon
1247Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1248link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1249
1250@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1251Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1252layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1253using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1254
cd6d6c15 1255@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1256Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1257is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1258This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1259
e6e2dfbd
AM
1260@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1261@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1262Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1263if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1264by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1265@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1266may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1267selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1268these options.
1269
6aa29e7b
JJ
1270@item execstack
1271Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1272
b039ef04
L
1273@item global
1274This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1275the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1276of subsequently loaded libraries.
1277
93ab9c0d
NC
1278@item globalaudit
1279This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1280This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1281setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1282tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1283the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1284all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1285
e6e2dfbd
AM
1286@item ibtplt
1287Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1288Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1289
8df93cb5 1290@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1291Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1292to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1293Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1294
cd6d6c15
NC
1295@item initfirst
1296This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1297It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1298before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1299the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1300the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1301objects.
1302
1303@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1304Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1305so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1306libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1307
5fa222e4
AM
1308@item lazy
1309When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1310dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1311the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1312Lazy binding is the default.
1313
cd6d6c15 1314@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1315Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1316
e6e2dfbd
AM
1317@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1318Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1319
e6e2dfbd
AM
1320@item muldefs
1321Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1322
cd6d6c15 1323@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1324Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1325defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1326
1327@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1328Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1329should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1330
1331@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1332Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1333
1334@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1335Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1336
1337@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1338Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1339
6aa29e7b
JJ
1340@item noexecstack
1341Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1342
e6e2dfbd
AM
1343@item noextern-protected-data
1344Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1345library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1346used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1347generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1348module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1349i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1350
e6e2dfbd
AM
1351@item noreloc-overflow
1352Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1353relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1354overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1355
cd6d6c15
NC
1356@item now
1357When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1358dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1359when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1360function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1361called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1362
1363@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1364Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1365
6aa29e7b 1366@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1367@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1368Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1369specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1370relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1371than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1372Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1373
47acac12
L
1374@item separate-code
1375@itemx noseparate-code
1376Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1377specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1378be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1379code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1380
e6e2dfbd
AM
1381@item shstk
1382Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1383to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1384Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1385
04c3a755 1386@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1387Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1388Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1389@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1390
cae64165
RM
1391@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1392@cindex visibility
1393@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1394Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1395@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1396Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1397@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1398start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1399compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1400recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1401programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1402between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1403
e6e2dfbd
AM
1404@item text
1405@itemx notext
1406@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1407Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1408or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1409report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1410
97a232d7
NC
1411@item undefs
1412Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1413either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1414This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1415
cd6d6c15
NC
1416@end table
1417
ece2d90e 1418Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1419
1420@kindex -(
1421@cindex groups of archives
1422@item -( @var{archives} -)
1423@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1424The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1425either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1426
1427The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1428references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1429the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1430archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1431object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1432would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1433they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1434resolved.
1435
1436Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1437it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1438more archives.
1439
69da35b5
NC
1440@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1441@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1442@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1443@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1444Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1445recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1446and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1447the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1448behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1449so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1450restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1451
4a43e768
AM
1452@kindex --as-needed
1453@kindex --no-as-needed
1454@item --as-needed
1455@itemx --no-as-needed
1456This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1457on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1458the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1459on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1460needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1461emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1462non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1463the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1464non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1465Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1466the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1467needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1468from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1469
e56f61be
L
1470@kindex --add-needed
1471@kindex --no-add-needed
1472@item --add-needed
1473@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1474These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1475their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1476options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1477and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1478
252b5132
RH
1479@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1480@item -assert @var{keyword}
1481This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1482
1483@kindex -Bdynamic
1484@kindex -dy
1485@kindex -call_shared
1486@item -Bdynamic
1487@itemx -dy
1488@itemx -call_shared
1489Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1490for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1491default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1492for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1493multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1494@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1495
a1ab1d2a
UD
1496@kindex -Bgroup
1497@item -Bgroup
1498Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1499section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1500object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1501@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1502only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1503
252b5132
RH
1504@kindex -Bstatic
1505@kindex -dn
1506@kindex -non_shared
1507@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1508@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1509@itemx -dn
1510@itemx -non_shared
1511@itemx -static
1512Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1513platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1514variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1515may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1516library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1517option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1518option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1519shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1520references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1521libraries.
252b5132
RH
1522
1523@kindex -Bsymbolic
1524@item -Bsymbolic
1525When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1526definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1527for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1528within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1529platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1530
40b36307
L
1531@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1532@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1533When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1534symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1535This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1536libraries.
40b36307 1537
55255dae
L
1538@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1539@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1540Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1541typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1542global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1543within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1544to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1545in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1546which support shared libraries.
1547
1548The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1549scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1550
40b36307
L
1551@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1552@item --dynamic-list-data
1553Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1554
1555@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1556@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1557Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1558is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1559
0b8a70d9
L
1560@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1561@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1562Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1563
252b5132
RH
1564@kindex --check-sections
1565@kindex --no-check-sections
1566@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1567@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1568Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1569been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1570perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1571suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1572allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1573restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1574Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1575force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1576option.
252b5132 1577
ddbb8a31
NC
1578@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1579@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1580@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1581@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1582This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1583by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1584command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1585output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1586input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1587specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1588follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1589behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1590
1591This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1592libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1593mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1594their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1595required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1596the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1597dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1598symbols.
1599
252b5132
RH
1600@cindex cross reference table
1601@kindex --cref
1602@item --cref
1603Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1604generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1605Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1606
1607The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1608easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1609sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1610symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1611definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1612where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1613symbol are listed.
252b5132 1614
4818e05f
AM
1615@cindex common allocation
1616@kindex --no-define-common
1617@item --no-define-common
1618This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1619The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1620@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1621
1622The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1623the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1624of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1625forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1626Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1627from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1628This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1629and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1630duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1631paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1632
7bdf4127
AB
1633@cindex group allocation in linker script
1634@cindex section groups
1635@cindex COMDAT
1636@kindex --force-group-allocation
1637@item --force-group-allocation
1638This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1639normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1640default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1641change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1642command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1643effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1644
252b5132 1645@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1646@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1647@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1648Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1649address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1650times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1651limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1652context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1653symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1654constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1655using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1656@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1657equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132
RH
1658
1659@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1660@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1661@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1662@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1663@itemx --no-demangle
1664These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1665and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1666present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1667underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1668mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1669different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1670to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1671demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1672is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1673
1674@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1675@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1676@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1677@item -I@var{file}
1678@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1679Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1680generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1681linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1682doing.
1683
9b8b325a
RF
1684@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1685@item --no-dynamic-linker
1686When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1687linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1688executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1689entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1690
a70f34c0
NC
1691@kindex --embedded-relocs
1692@item --embedded-relocs
1693This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1694that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1695is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1696targets.
1697
3f0a5f17
ME
1698@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1699@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1700Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1701in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1702
7ce691ae 1703@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1704@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1705@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1706@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1707Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1708with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1709
252b5132
RH
1710@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1711@item --force-exe-suffix
1712Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1713
1714If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1715@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1716the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1717option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1718Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1719it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1720
1721@kindex --gc-sections
1722@kindex --no-gc-sections
1723@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1724@item --gc-sections
1725@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1726Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1727targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1728performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1729@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1730collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1731implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1732
d5465ba2
AM
1733@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1734examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1735symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1736command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1737referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1738libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1739referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1740the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1741relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1742@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1743
ac69cbc6 1744This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1745@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1746specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1747@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1748command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1749
c17d87de
NC
1750@kindex --print-gc-sections
1751@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1752@cindex garbage collection
1753@item --print-gc-sections
1754@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1755List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1756printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1757collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1758default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1759be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1760line.
1761
22185505 1762@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1763@cindex garbage collection
1764@item --gc-keep-exported
1765When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1766collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1767default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1768executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1769collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1770Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1771it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1772ELF format targets.
1773
30824704
RM
1774@kindex --print-output-format
1775@cindex output format
1776@item --print-output-format
1777Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1778other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1779in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1780
3604cb1f
TG
1781@kindex --print-memory-usage
1782@cindex memory usage
1783@item --print-memory-usage
1784Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1785the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1786quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1787headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1788parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1789
1790@smallexample
1791Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1792 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1793 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1794@end smallexample
1795
252b5132
RH
1796@cindex help
1797@cindex usage
1798@kindex --help
1799@item --help
1800Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1801
ea20a7da
CC
1802@kindex --target-help
1803@item --target-help
a094d01f 1804Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1805
2509a395
SL
1806@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1807@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1808Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
72a3b182
NC
1809@option{-M} option, above. Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile}
1810causes the linker map to be written into a file inside the directory.
1811The name of the file is based upon the @var{output} filename with
1812@code{.map} appended.
252b5132
RH
1813
1814@cindex memory usage
1815@kindex --no-keep-memory
1816@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1817@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1818symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1819instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1820necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1821while linking a large executable.
1822
1823@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1824@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1825@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1826@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1827@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
1828Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1829is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1830The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1831behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 1832libraries being linked in.
252b5132 1833
97a232d7
NC
1834The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1835
aa713662
L
1836@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1837@kindex -z muldefs
1838@item --allow-multiple-definition
1839@itemx -z muldefs
1840Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1841report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1842first definition will be used.
1843
b79e8c78 1844@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1845@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 1846@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1847@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 1848Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
1849This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1850determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1851shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1852how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1853
903249d7
NC
1854The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
1855referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
1856an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
1857a shared library.
1858
1859The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
1860libraries specified at link time are that:
1861
1862@itemize @bullet
1863@item
1864A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
1865that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
1866resolvable at load time.
1867@item
1868There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
1869symbols in shared libraries are normal.
1870
1871The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
1872select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
1873architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
1874appropriate memset function.
1875@end itemize
b79e8c78 1876
31941635
L
1877@kindex --no-undefined-version
1878@item --no-undefined-version
1879Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
1880it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
1881will be issued instead.
1882
3e3b46e5
PB
1883@kindex --default-symver
1884@item --default-symver
1885Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
1886exported symbols.
1887
1888@kindex --default-imported-symver
1889@item --default-imported-symver
1890Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1891imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 1892
252b5132
RH
1893@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
1894@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 1895Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
1896files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
1897been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 1898This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
1899errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
1900have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
1901inappropriate.
1902
fe7929ce
AM
1903@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
1904@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
1905Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
1906library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
1907
252b5132
RH
1908@kindex --no-whole-archive
1909@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 1910Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
1911archive files.
1912
1913@cindex output file after errors
1914@kindex --noinhibit-exec
1915@item --noinhibit-exec
1916Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
1917Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
1918errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
1919when it issues any error whatsoever.
1920
0a9c1c8e
CD
1921@kindex -nostdlib
1922@item -nostdlib
1923Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
1924command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
1925(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
1926
252b5132 1927@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
1928@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
1929@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
1930@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
1931file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 1932@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
1933object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
1934object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
1935should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
1936usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
1937name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
1938list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
1939command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
1940this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
1941@end ifclear
1942
76359541
TP
1943@kindex --out-implib
1944@item --out-implib @var{file}
1945Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
1946the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
1947library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
1948may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
1949behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
1950step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
1951the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
1952
36af4a4e
JJ
1953@kindex -pie
1954@kindex --pic-executable
1955@item -pie
1956@itemx --pic-executable
1957@cindex position independent executables
1958Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
1959ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
1960libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 1961address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
1962normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
1963defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
1964
252b5132
RH
1965@kindex -qmagic
1966@item -qmagic
1967This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
1968
1969@kindex -Qy
1970@item -Qy
1971This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
1972
1973@kindex --relax
1974@cindex synthesizing linker
1975@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 1976@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 1977@item --relax
28d5f677 1978@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 1979An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
1980@ifset GENERIC
1981This option is only supported on a few targets.
1982@end ifset
1983@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 1984@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 1985@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
1986@ifset XTENSA
1987@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
1988@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
1989@ifset M68HC11
1990@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
1991@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
1992@ifset NIOSII
1993@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
1994@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
1995@ifset POWERPC
1996@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
1997@end ifset
252b5132 1998
a094d01f 1999On some platforms the @samp{--relax} option performs target-specific,
28d5f677
NC
2000global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2001addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2002synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2003instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2004
2005On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2006debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2007@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2008This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2009family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2010@end ifset
2011
2012@ifset GENERIC
2013On platforms where this is not supported, @samp{--relax} is accepted,
2014but ignored.
2015@end ifset
2016
28d5f677
NC
2017On platforms where @samp{--relax} is accepted the option
2018@samp{--no-relax} can be used to disable the feature.
2019
252b5132
RH
2020@cindex retaining specified symbols
2021@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2022@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2023@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2024@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2025Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2026discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2027symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2028@ifset GENERIC
2029(such as VxWorks)
2030@end ifset
2031where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2032run-time memory.
2033
2034@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2035or symbols needed for relocations.
2036
2037You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2038line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2039
2040@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2041@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2042@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2043@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2044Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2045linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2046arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2047them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2048
2049The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2050are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2051description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2052in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2053have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2054
2055If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2056contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2057is defined.
252b5132 2058
ff5dcc92 2059The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2060SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2061@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2062runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2063options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2064gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2065file systems.
252b5132 2066
ff5dcc92 2067For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2068followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2069the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2070@end ifset
2071
2072@ifset GENERIC
2073@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2074@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2075@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2076When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2077happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2078of the input files.
2079
2080When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2081non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2082shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2083explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2084specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2085@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2086either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2087appearing multiple times.
2088
e680a6b6
NC
2089The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2090directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2091containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2092and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
209364-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2094
2095The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2096@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2097supported.
2098
28c309a2
NC
2099This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2100that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2101is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2102runtime linker would do.
2103
252b5132 2104The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2105libraries:
d8e4137b 2106
252b5132
RH
2107@enumerate
2108@item
ff5dcc92 2109Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2110@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2111Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2112between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2113specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2114used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2115at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2116by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2117the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2118@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2119On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2120@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2121environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2122@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2123On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2124directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2125@item
a1b8d843 2126For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2127variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2128@item
ec4eb78a
L
2129For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2130@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2131libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2132@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2133@item
252b5132
RH
2134The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2135@item
d8e4137b
NC
2136For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2137exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2138to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2139defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2140configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2141@item
2142For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2143the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2144header file.
2145@item
2146Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2147linker script being used.
252b5132
RH
2148@end enumerate
2149
2150If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2151warning and continue with the link.
2152@end ifset
2153
2154@kindex -shared
2155@kindex -Bshareable
2156@item -shared
2157@itemx -Bshareable
2158@cindex shared libraries
2159Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2160and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2161shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2162undefined symbols in the link.
2163
252b5132 2164@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2165@item --sort-common
2166@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2167@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2168This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2169ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2170sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2171eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2172between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2173specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2174
2509a395
SL
2175@kindex --sort-section=name
2176@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2177This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2178patterns in the linker script.
2179
2509a395
SL
2180@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2181@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2182This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2183patterns in the linker script.
2184
a70f34c0
NC
2185@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2186@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2187This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2188.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2189post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2190
252b5132 2191@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2192@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2193Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2194each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2195size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2196
2197@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2198@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2199Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2200output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2201This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2202certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2203cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2204that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2205support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2206input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2207more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2208many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2209
2210@kindex --stats
2211@item --stats
2212Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2213as execution time and memory usage.
2214
2509a395 2215@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2216@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2217Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2218configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2219that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2220
a70f34c0
NC
2221@kindex --task-link
2222@item --task-link
2223This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2224file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2225
252b5132
RH
2226@kindex --traditional-format
2227@cindex traditional format
2228@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2229For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2230the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2231use the traditional format instead.
2232
2233@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2234For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2235symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2236full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2237@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2238trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2239combine duplicate entries.
2240
2509a395
SL
2241@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2242@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2243Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2244address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2245times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2246line.
2247@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2248for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2249@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2250should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2251sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2252
2509a395
SL
2253@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2254@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2255@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2256@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2257@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2258@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2259@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2260Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2261@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2262
2509a395
SL
2263@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2264@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2265@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2266When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2267byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2268
9d5777a3
RM
2269@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2270@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2271@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2272When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2273the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2274text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2275
0d705e9f
AM
2276@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2277@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2278@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2279When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2280model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2281
560e09e9
NC
2282@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2283@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2284Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2285values for @samp{method}:
2286
2287@table @samp
2288@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2289Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2290
2291@item report-all
da8bce14 2292Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2293
2294@item ignore-in-object-files
2295Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2296ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2297
2298@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2299Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2300ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2301when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2302libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2303command line.
2304@end table
2305
2306The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2307by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2308
2309Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2310unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2311can change this to a warning.
2312
1715a13c
L
2313@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2314@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2315@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2316@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2317Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2318supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2319the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2320argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2321
2322@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2323@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2324@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2325Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2326used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2327about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2328is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2329see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2330use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2331symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2332@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2333
7ce691ae 2334@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2335@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2336@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2337@item --warn-common
2338Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2339a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2340but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2341you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2342Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2343warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2344
2345There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2346
2347@table @samp
2348@item int i = 1;
2349A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2350file.
2351
2352@item extern int i;
2353An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2354There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2355variable somewhere.
2356
2357@item int i;
2358A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2359variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2360The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2361single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2362size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2363a definition of the same variable.
2364@end table
2365
2366The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2367Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2368just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2369encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2370a common symbol.
2371
2372@enumerate
2373@item
2374Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2375definition for the symbol.
2376@smallexample
2377@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2378 overridden by definition
2379@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2380@end smallexample
2381
2382@item
2383Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2384the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2385except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2386@smallexample
2387@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2388 overriding common
2389@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2390@end smallexample
2391
2392@item
2393Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2394@smallexample
2395@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2396 of `@var{symbol}'
2397@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2398@end smallexample
2399
2400@item
2401Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2402@smallexample
2403@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2404 overridden by larger common
2405@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2406@end smallexample
2407
2408@item
2409Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2410the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2411encountered in a different order.
2412@smallexample
2413@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2414 overriding smaller common
2415@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2416@end smallexample
2417@end enumerate
2418
2419@kindex --warn-constructors
2420@item --warn-constructors
2421Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2422object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2423detect the use of global constructors.
2424
2425@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2426@item --warn-multiple-gp
2427Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2428This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2429Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2430section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2431of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2432base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2433base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2434bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2435large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2436values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2437option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2438
2439@kindex --warn-once
2440@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2441@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2442@item --warn-once
2443Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2444which refers to it.
2445
2446@kindex --warn-section-align
2447@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2448@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2449@item --warn-section-align
2450Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2451alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2452The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2453is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2454the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2455
a6dbf402
L
2456@kindex --warn-textrel
2457@item --warn-textrel
2458Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2459or shared object.
8fdd7217 2460
a0c402a5
L
2461@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2462@item --warn-alternate-em
2463Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2464
560e09e9
NC
2465@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2466@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2467If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2468@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2469This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2470
2471@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2472@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2473This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2474it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2475
252b5132
RH
2476@kindex --whole-archive
2477@cindex including an entire archive
2478@item --whole-archive
2479For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2480@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2481in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2482files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2483library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2484library. This option may be used more than once.
2485
7ec229ce 2486Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2487about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2488Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2489list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2490your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2491
2509a395
SL
2492@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2493@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2494Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2495@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2496undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2497@var{symbol}.
2498
2499This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2500wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2501wishes to call the system function, it should call
2502@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2503
2504Here is a trivial example:
2505
2506@smallexample
2507void *
cc2f008e 2508__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2509@{
cc2f008e 2510 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2511 return __real_malloc (c);
2512@}
2513@end smallexample
2514
ff5dcc92 2515If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2516all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2517instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2518call the real @code{malloc} function.
2519
2520You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2521links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2522you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2523file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2524call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2525
4ea904ed
SH
2526Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2527internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2528@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2529@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2530
2531@smallexample
2532int
2533f (void)
2534@{
2535 return 123;
2536@}
2537
2538int
2539g (void)
2540@{
2541 return f();
2542@}
2543@end smallexample
2544
6aa29e7b 2545@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2546@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2547@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2548@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2549Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2550(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2551section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2552
e41b3a13
JJ
2553@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2554@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2555Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2556generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2557if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2558
6c1439be
L
2559@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2560@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2561@item --enable-new-dtags
2562@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2563This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2564systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2565@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2566and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2567If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2568created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2569those options are only available for ELF systems.
2570
2d643429 2571@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2572@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2573Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2574close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2575time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2576increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2577value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2578
fdc90cb4
JJ
2579@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2580@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2581Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2582@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2583new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2584the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2585hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2586but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2587
0ce398f1
L
2588@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2589@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2590@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2591@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2592@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2593@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2594@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2595@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2596On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2597compressed using zlib.
2598
2599@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2600sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2601DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2602instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2603also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2604sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2605
2606The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2607@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2608
2609Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2610sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2611for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2612uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2613
2614The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2615involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2616default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2617@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2618
35835446
JR
2619@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2620@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2621This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2622linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2623for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2624about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2625
4f9c04f7 2626Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 26271021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2628run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2629has been used.
2630
2631The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2632enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2633
c0065db7
RM
2634@kindex --build-id
2635@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2636@item --build-id
2637@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2638Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2639or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2640unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2641@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2642@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2643@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2644the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2645string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2646@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2647is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2648
2649The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2650that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2651unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2652to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2653file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2654string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2655
2656Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2657@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2658@end table
2659
0285c67d
NC
2660@c man end
2661
36f63dca 2662@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2663
0285c67d
NC
2664@c man begin OPTIONS
2665
ff5dcc92 2666The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2667the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2668normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2669use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2670@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2671like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2672symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2673object file).
2674
2675In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2676support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2677PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2678values by either a space or an equals sign.
2679
ff5dcc92 2680@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2681
2682@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2683@item --add-stdcall-alias
2684If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2685as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2686[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2687
2688@kindex --base-file
2689@item --base-file @var{file}
2690Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2691addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2692@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2693[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2694
2695@kindex --dll
2696@item --dll
2697Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2698@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2699file.
bb10df36 2700[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2701
88183869
DK
2702@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2703@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2704@item --enable-long-section-names
2705@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2706The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2707the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2708for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2709fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2710to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2711allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2712disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2713generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2714as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2715with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2716GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2717information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2718option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2719section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2720when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2721image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2722[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2723
252b5132
RH
2724@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2725@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2726@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2727@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2728If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2729do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2730only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2731resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2732undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2733@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2734to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2735warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2736import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2737to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2738feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2739@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2740mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2741[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2742
522f09cd
KT
2743@kindex --leading-underscore
2744@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2745@item --leading-underscore
2746@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2747For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2748in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2749disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2750
252b5132
RH
2751@cindex DLLs, creating
2752@kindex --export-all-symbols
2753@item --export-all-symbols
2754If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2755be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2756otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2757explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2758attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2759option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2760@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2761@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2762exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2763re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2764such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2765@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2766@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2767Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2768not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2769extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2770(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2771These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2772@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2773@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2774@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2775@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2776[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2777
2778@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2779@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2780Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2781exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2782[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2783
2927aaca
NC
2784@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2785@item --exclude-all-symbols
2786Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2787[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2788
252b5132
RH
2789@kindex --file-alignment
2790@item --file-alignment
2791Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2792file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2793512.
bb10df36 2794[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2795
2796@cindex heap size
2797@kindex --heap
2798@item --heap @var{reserve}
2799@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 2800Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 2801to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 2802committed.
bb10df36 2803[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2804
2805@cindex image base
2806@kindex --image-base
2807@item --image-base @var{value}
2808Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2809the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2810is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2811your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2812other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2813for dlls.
bb10df36 2814[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2815
2816@kindex --kill-at
2817@item --kill-at
2818If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2819symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 2820[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2821
26d2d8a2
BF
2822@kindex --large-address-aware
2823@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 2824If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 2825header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 2826greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
2827or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2828section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2829[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2830
f69a2f97
NC
2831@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2832@item --disable-large-address-aware
2833Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2834This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2835driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2836addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2837[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2838
252b5132
RH
2839@kindex --major-image-version
2840@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2841Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 2842[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2843
2844@kindex --major-os-version
2845@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2846Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2847[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2848
2849@kindex --major-subsystem-version
2850@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2851Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2852[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2853
2854@kindex --minor-image-version
2855@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2856Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2857[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2858
2859@kindex --minor-os-version
2860@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2861Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2862[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2863
2864@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
2865@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2866Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2867[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2868
2869@cindex DEF files, creating
2870@cindex DLLs, creating
2871@kindex --output-def
2872@item --output-def @var{file}
2873The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
2874file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
2875(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
2876library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
2877automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 2878[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2879
b044cda1 2880@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
2881@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
2882@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
2883@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
2884Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
2885@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
2886By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
2887for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
2888execution are avoided.
bb10df36 2889[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2890
2891@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
2892@item --disable-auto-image-base
2893Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
2894user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
2895default.
bb10df36 2896[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2897
2898@cindex DLLs, linking to
2899@kindex --dll-search-prefix
2900@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 2901When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 2902search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 2903@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
2904between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
2905uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 2906@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 2907[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2908
2909@kindex --enable-auto-import
2910@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 2911Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
2912DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
2913mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
2914[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2915
2916The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
2917feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
2918
2919Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
2920of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
2921PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 2922
e2a83dd0
NC
2923Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
2924data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
2925placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
2926around a problem with consts that is described here:
2927http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
2928
4d8907ac
DS
2929Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
2930see this message:
0d888aac 2931
ece2d90e 2932"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
2933documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
2934
ece2d90e
NC
2935This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
2936ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
2937allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
2938fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
2939constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
2940multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
2941this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
2942of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
2943the warning, and exit.
2944
2945There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
2946data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 2947
2fa9fc65
NC
2948One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
2949of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 2950this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 2951
c0065db7
RM
2952A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
2953that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
2954there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
2955a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
2956
2957@example
2958extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 2959extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
2960 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
2961@end example
2962
2963or
2964
2965@example
2966extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 2967extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
2968 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
2969@end example
2970
c0065db7 2971For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 2972is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
2973
2974@example
2975extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 2976extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
2977 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
2978@end example
2979
c406afaf
NC
2980or
2981
2982@example
2983extern long long extern_ll;
2984extern_ll -->
2985 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
2986@end example
2987
2fa9fc65 2988A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 2989'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 2990@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 2991requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
2992building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
2993merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
2994between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
2995constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
2996
2997Original:
2998@example
2999--foo.h
3000extern int arr[];
3001--foo.c
3002#include "foo.h"
3003void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3004 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3005@}
3006@end example
3007
3008Solution 1:
3009@example
3010--foo.h
3011extern int arr[];
3012--foo.c
3013#include "foo.h"
3014void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3015 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3016 volatile int *parr = arr;
3017 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3018@}
3019@end example
3020
3021Solution 2:
3022@example
3023--foo.h
3024/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3025#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3026 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3027#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3028#else
3029#define FOO_IMPORT
3030#endif
3031extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3032--foo.c
3033#include "foo.h"
3034void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3035 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3036@}
3037@end example
3038
c0065db7 3039A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3040library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3041for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3042functions).
b044cda1
CW
3043
3044@kindex --disable-auto-import
3045@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3046Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3047@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3048[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3049
2fa9fc65
NC
3050@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3051@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3052If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3053that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3054a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3055environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3056[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3057
3058@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3059@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3060Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3061[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3062
b044cda1
CW
3063@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3064@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3065Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3066[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3067
252b5132
RH
3068@kindex --section-alignment
3069@item --section-alignment
3070Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3071addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3072[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3073
3074@cindex stack size
3075@kindex --stack
3076@item --stack @var{reserve}
3077@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3078Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3079to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3080committed.
bb10df36 3081[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3082
3083@kindex --subsystem
3084@item --subsystem @var{which}
3085@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3086@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3087Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3088legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3089@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3090the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3091@var{which}.
bb10df36 3092[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3093
2f563b51
DK
3094The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3095of the PE file header:
3096[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3097
2d5c3743
NC
3098@kindex --high-entropy-va
3099@item --high-entropy-va
3100Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3101(ASLR).
dc9bd8c9
HD
3102This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3103@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3104
2f563b51
DK
3105@kindex --dynamicbase
3106@item --dynamicbase
3107The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3108randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3109Vista for i386 PE targets.
dc9bd8c9 3110This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3111
3112@kindex --forceinteg
3113@item --forceinteg
3114Code integrity checks are enforced.
3115
3116@kindex --nxcompat
3117@item --nxcompat
3118The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3119This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE targets.
3120
3121@kindex --no-isolation
3122@item --no-isolation
3123Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3124
3125@kindex --no-seh
3126@item --no-seh
3127The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3128this image.
3129
3130@kindex --no-bind
3131@item --no-bind
3132Do not bind this image.
3133
3134@kindex --wdmdriver
3135@item --wdmdriver
3136The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model.
9d5777a3 3137
2f563b51
DK
3138@kindex --tsaware
3139@item --tsaware
3140The image is Terminal Server aware.
3141
0cb112f7
CF
3142@kindex --insert-timestamp
3143@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3144@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3145Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3146as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3147other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3148will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3149same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3150can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3151that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3152identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3153
3154@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3155@item --enable-reloc-section
3156Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3157is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
252b5132
RH
3158@end table
3159
0285c67d
NC
3160@c man end
3161
ac145307
BS
3162@ifset C6X
3163@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3164
3165@c man begin OPTIONS
3166
3167The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3168libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3169all executables use an index of 0.
3170
3171@table @gcctabopt
3172
3173@kindex --dsbt-size
3174@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3175This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3176or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3177entries.
3178
3179@kindex --dsbt-index
3180@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3181This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3182to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3183executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3184@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3185
fbd9ad90
PB
3186@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3187The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3188exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3189
ac145307
BS
3190@end table
3191
3192@c man end
3193@end ifset
3194
b8891f8d
AJ
3195@ifset CSKY
3196@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3197
3198@c man begin OPTIONS
3199
3200@table @gcctabopt
3201
3202@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3203@item --branch-stub
3204This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3205sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3206usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3207can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3208the compiler or assembler.
3209
3210@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3211@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3212This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3213It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3214be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3215stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3216sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3217@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3218linker should choose suitable defaults.
3219
3220@end table
3221
3222@c man end
3223@end ifset
3224
93fd0973
SC
3225@ifset M68HC11
3226@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3227
3228@c man begin OPTIONS
3229
3230The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3231memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3232
3233@table @gcctabopt
3234
3235@kindex --no-trampoline
3236@item --no-trampoline
3237This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3238is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3239instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3240
3241@kindex --bank-window
3242@item --bank-window @var{name}
3243This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3244the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3245The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3246paging and addresses within the memory window.
3247
3248@end table
3249
3250@c man end
3251@end ifset
3252
7fb9f789
NC
3253@ifset M68K
3254@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3255
3256@c man begin OPTIONS
3257
3258The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3259when linking for 68K targets.
3260
3261@table @gcctabopt
3262
3263@kindex --got
3264@item --got=@var{type}
3265This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3266@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3267@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3268Info entry for @file{ld}.
3269
3270@end table
3271
3272@c man end
3273@end ifset
3274
833794fc
MR
3275@ifset MIPS
3276@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3277
3278@c man begin OPTIONS
3279
3280The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3281generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3282linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3283
3284@table @gcctabopt
3285
3286@kindex --insn32
3287@item --insn32
3288@kindex --no-insn32
3289@itemx --no-insn32
3290These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3291generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3292or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
329332-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3294used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3295possible.
3296
8b10b0b3
MR
3297@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3298@item --ignore-branch-isa
3299@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3300@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3301These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3302transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3303accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3304is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3305instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3306equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3307calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3308a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3309an error.
3310
3734320d
MF
3311@kindex --compact-branches
3312@item --compact-branches
3313@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3314@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3315These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3316in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3317
833794fc
MR
3318@end table
3319
3320@c man end
3321@end ifset
3322
fa1477dc
SC
3323
3324@ifset PDP11
3325@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3326
3327@c man begin OPTIONS
3328
3329For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3330produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3331for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3332targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3333defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3334here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3335
3336@table @gcctabopt
3337
3338@kindex -N
3339@item -N
3340@kindex --omagic
3341@itemx --omagic
3342
3343Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3344indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3345shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3346writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3347the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3348programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3349from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3350
3351@kindex -n
3352@item -n
3353@kindex --nmagic
3354@itemx --nmagic
3355
3356Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3357indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3358be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3359file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3360byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3361a @emph{pure executable} format.
3362
3363@kindex -z
3364@item -z
3365@kindex --imagic
3366@itemx --imagic
3367
3368Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3369indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3370data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3371instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3372larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3373to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3374shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3375option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3376and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3377this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3378executable} format.
3379
3380@kindex --no-omagic
3381@item --no-omagic
3382
3383Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3384
3385@end table
3386
3387@c man end
3388@end ifset
3389
252b5132
RH
3390@ifset UsesEnvVars
3391@node Environment
3392@section Environment Variables
3393
0285c67d
NC
3394@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3395
560e09e9 3396You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3397@ifclear SingleFormat
3398@code{GNUTARGET},
3399@end ifclear
3400@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3401
36f63dca 3402@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3403@kindex GNUTARGET
3404@cindex default input format
3405@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3406use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3407of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3408@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3409of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3410attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3411this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3412there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3413object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3414BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3415in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3416@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3417
3418@kindex LDEMULATION
3419@cindex default emulation
3420@cindex emulation, default
3421@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3422@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3423behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3424available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3425the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3426variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3427linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3428
3429@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3430@cindex demangling, default
3431Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3432@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3433default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3434a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3435may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3436options.
3437
0285c67d
NC
3438@c man end
3439@end ifset
3440
252b5132
RH
3441@node Scripts
3442@chapter Linker Scripts
3443
3444@cindex scripts
3445@cindex linker scripts
3446@cindex command files
3447Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3448written in the linker command language.
3449
3450The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3451the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3452the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3453more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3454direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3455described below.
3456
3457The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3458yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3459linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3460to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3461such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3462
3463You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3464line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3465default linker script.
3466
3467You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3468to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3469Linker Scripts}.
3470
3471@menu
3472* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3473* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3474* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3475* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3476* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3477* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3478* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3479* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3480* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3481* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3482* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3483@end menu
3484
3485@node Basic Script Concepts
3486@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3487@cindex linker script concepts
3488We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3489describe the linker script language.
3490
3491The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3492file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3493@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3494The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3495purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3496among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3497section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3498in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3499
3500Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3501also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3502contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3503the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3504A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3505area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3506loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3507which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3508of debugging information.
3509
3510Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3511first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3512the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3513@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3514section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3515same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3516is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3517(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3518based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3519RAM address would be the VMA.
3520
3521You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3522program with the @samp{-h} option.
3523
3524Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3525@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3526has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3527information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3528will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3529static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3530referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3531
3532You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3533program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3534option.
3535
3536@node Script Format
3537@section Linker Script Format
3538@cindex linker script format
3539Linker scripts are text files.
3540
3541You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3542either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3543symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3544generally ignored.
3545
3546Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3547If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3548otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3549double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3550file name.
3551
3552You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3553@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3554to whitespace.
3555
3556@node Simple Example
3557@section Simple Linker Script Example
3558@cindex linker script example
3559@cindex example of linker script
3560Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3561
3562The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3563@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3564memory layout of the output file.
3565
3566The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3567describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3568code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3569@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3570Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3571your input files.
3572
3573For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
35740x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3575linker script which will do that:
3576@smallexample
3577SECTIONS
3578@{
3579 . = 0x10000;
3580 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3581 . = 0x8000000;
3582 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3583 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3584@}
3585@end smallexample
3586
3587You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3588followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3589descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3590
252b5132
RH
3591The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3592sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3593counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3594other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3595current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3596incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3597@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3598
3599The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3600required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3601after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3602which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3603wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3604means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3605
3606Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3607@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3608@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3609
3610The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3611the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3612at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3613output section, the value of the location counter will be
3614@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3615effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3616immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3617
3618The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3619alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3620example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3621sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3622may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3623sections.
3624
3625That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3626
3627@node Simple Commands
3628@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3629@cindex linker script simple commands
3630In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3631
3632@menu
3633* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3634* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3635@ifclear SingleFormat
3636* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3637@end ifclear
3638
4a93e180 3639* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3640* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3641@end menu
3642
3643@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3644@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3645@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3646@cindex start of execution
3647@cindex first instruction
3648@cindex entry point
3649The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3650point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3651entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3652@smallexample
3653ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3654@end smallexample
3655
3656There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3657entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3658stopping when one of them succeeds:
3659@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3660@item
252b5132 3661the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3662@item
252b5132 3663the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3664@item
a094d01f 3665the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3666targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3667check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3668@item
252b5132 3669the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3670@item
252b5132
RH
3671The address @code{0}.
3672@end itemize
3673
3674@node File Commands
36f63dca 3675@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3676@cindex linker script file commands
3677Several linker script commands deal with files.
3678
3679@table @code
3680@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3681@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3682@cindex including a linker script
3683Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3684be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3685with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
368610 levels deep.
3687
4006703d
NS
3688You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3689@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3690
252b5132
RH
3691@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3692@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3693@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3694@cindex input files in linker scripts
3695@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3696@cindex linker script input object files
3697The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3698in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3699
3700For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3701a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3702then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3703
3704In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3705script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3706
e3f2db7f
AO
3707In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3708with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3709located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3710for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3711@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3712filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3713@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3714
3715If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3716the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3717found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3718not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3719path.
252b5132 3720
ff5dcc92 3721If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3722name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3723@samp{-l}.
3724
3725When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3726files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3727script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3728
3729@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3730@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3731@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3732@cindex grouping input files
3733The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3734files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3735new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3736in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3737
b717d30e
JJ
3738@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3739@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3740@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3741This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3742commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3743as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3744with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3745when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3746@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3747and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3748setting afterwards.
3749
252b5132
RH
3750@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3751@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3752@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3753The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3754@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3755@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3756Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3757precedence.
3758
3759You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3760output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3761
3762@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3763@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3764@cindex library search path in linker script
3765@cindex archive search path in linker script
3766@cindex search path in linker script
3767The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3768@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3769@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3770on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3771are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3772the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3773
3774@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3775@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3776@cindex first input file
3777The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3778that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3779though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3780when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3781first file.
3782@end table
3783
3784@ifclear SingleFormat
3785@node Format Commands
36f63dca 3786@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
3787A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3788
3789@table @code
3790@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3791@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3792@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3793@cindex output file format in linker script
3794The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3795output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 3796exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3797(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
3798line option takes precedence.
3799
3800You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 3801formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
3802This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3803desired endianness.
3804
3805If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3806will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3807output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3808used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3809
3810For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3811command:
3812@smallexample
3813OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3814@end smallexample
3815This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 3816@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
3817option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3818format.
3819
3820@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3821@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3822@cindex input file format in linker script
3823The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
3824files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
3825This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3826(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
3827is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
3828command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
3829@end table
3830@end ifclear
3831
4a93e180
NC
3832@node REGION_ALIAS
3833@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
3834@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3835@cindex region alias
3836@cindex region names
3837
3838Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
3839@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
3840
3841@smallexample
3842REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3843@end smallexample
3844
3845The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
3846memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
3847to memory regions. An example follows.
3848
3849Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
3850memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
3851that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
3852non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
3853access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
3854read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
3855sections:
3856
3857@itemize @bullet
3858@item
3859@code{.text} program code;
3860@item
3861@code{.rodata} read-only data;
3862@item
3863@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
3864@item
3865@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
3866@end itemize
3867
3868The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
3869part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
3870output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
3871systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
3872@code{C}:
3873@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
3874@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 3875@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
3876@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
3877@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
3878@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
3879@end multitable
3880The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
3881loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
3882the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
3883the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
3884
3885The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
3886includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
3887memory layout:
3888@smallexample
3889INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
3890
3891SECTIONS
3892 @{
3893 .text :
3894 @{
3895 *(.text)
3896 @} > REGION_TEXT
3897 .rodata :
3898 @{
3899 *(.rodata)
3900 rodata_end = .;
3901 @} > REGION_RODATA
3902 .data : AT (rodata_end)
3903 @{
3904 data_start = .;
3905 *(.data)
3906 @} > REGION_DATA
3907 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
3908 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
3909 .bss :
3910 @{
3911 *(.bss)
3912 @} > REGION_BSS
3913 @}
3914@end smallexample
3915
3916Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
3917regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
3918variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
3919@table @code
3920@item A
3921Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
3922@smallexample
3923MEMORY
3924 @{
3925 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
3926 @}
3927
3928REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
3929REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
3930REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
3931REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
3932@end smallexample
3933@item B
3934Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
3935into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
3936@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
3937@smallexample
3938MEMORY
3939 @{
3940 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
3941 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
3942 @}
3943
3944REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
3945REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
3946REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
3947REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
3948@end smallexample
3949@item C
3950Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
3951@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
3952initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
3953system start into the @code{RAM}.
3954@smallexample
3955MEMORY
3956 @{
3957 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
3958 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
3959 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
3960 @}
3961
3962REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
3963REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
3964REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
3965REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
3966@end smallexample
3967@end table
3968
3969It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
3970@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
3971necessary:
3972@smallexample
3973#include <string.h>
3974
3975extern char data_start [];
3976extern char data_size [];
3977extern char data_load_start [];
3978
3979void copy_data(void)
3980@{
3981 if (data_start != data_load_start)
3982 @{
3983 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
3984 @}
3985@}
3986@end smallexample
3987
252b5132 3988@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 3989@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
3990There are a few other linker scripts commands.
3991
3992@table @code
3993@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
3994@kindex ASSERT
3995@cindex assertion in linker script
3996Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
3997with an error code, and print @var{message}.
3998
fd1c4238
NC
3999Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4000take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4001inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4002for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4003symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4004
4005@smallexample
4006 .stack :
4007 @{
4008 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4009 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4010 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4011 @}
4012@end smallexample
4013
4014will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4015PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4016can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4017
4018@smallexample
4019 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4020 .stack :
4021 @{
4022 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4023 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4024 @}
4025@end smallexample
4026
4027will work.
4028
252b5132
RH
4029@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4030@kindex EXTERN
4031@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4032Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4033symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4034modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4035each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4036command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4037
4038@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4039@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4040@cindex common allocation in linker script
4041This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4042to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4043output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4044
4818e05f
AM
4045@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4046@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4047@cindex common allocation in linker script
4048This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4049command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4050to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4051
7bdf4127
AB
4052@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4053@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4054@cindex group allocation in linker script
4055@cindex section groups
4056@cindex COMDAT
4057This command has the same effect as the
4058@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4059@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4060and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4061specified (@samp{-r}).
4062
53d25da6
AM
4063@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4064@kindex INSERT
4065@cindex insert user script into default script
4066This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4067augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4068inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4069@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4070default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4071sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4072linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4073insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4074linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4075default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4076of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4077to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4078is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4079
4080@smallexample
4081SECTIONS
4082@{
4083 OVERLAY :
4084 @{
4085 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4086 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4087 @}
4088@}
4089INSERT AFTER .text;
4090@end smallexample
4091
252b5132
RH
4092@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4093@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4094@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4095This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4096references among certain output sections.
4097
4098In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4099using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4100will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4101errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4102a function defined in the other section.
4103
4104The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4105@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4106an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4107@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4108names.
4109
cdf96953
MF
4110@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4111@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4112@cindex cross references
4113This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4114references to one section from a list of other sections.
4115
4116The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4117output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4118a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4119there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4120must never call back.
4121
4122The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4123The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4124If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4125the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4126status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4127names, not input section names.
4128
252b5132
RH
4129@ifclear SingleFormat
4130@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4131@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4132@cindex machine architecture
4133@cindex architecture
4134Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4135of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4136architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4137the @samp{-f} option.
4138@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4139
4140@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4141@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4142This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4143@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4144in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4145@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4146@end table
4147
4148@node Assignments
4149@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4150@cindex assignment in scripts
4151@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4152@cindex variables, defining
4153You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4154the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4155
4156@menu
4157* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4158* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4159* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4160* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4161* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4162@end menu
4163
4164@node Simple Assignments
4165@subsection Simple Assignments
4166
4167You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4168
4169@table @code
4170@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4171@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4172@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4173@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4174@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4175@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4176@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4177@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4178@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4179@end table
4180
4181The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4182@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4183defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4184
4185The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4186may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4187
4188The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4189
4190Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4191
4192You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4193statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4194section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4195
4196The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4197expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4198
4199Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4200assignments may be used:
4201
4202@smallexample
4203floating_point = 0;
4204SECTIONS
4205@{
4206 .text :
4207 @{
4208 *(.text)
4209 _etext = .;
4210 @}
156e34dd 4211 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4212 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4213@}
4214@end smallexample
4215@noindent
4216In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4217zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4218the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4219defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4220upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4221
eb8476a6
MR
4222@node HIDDEN
4223@subsection HIDDEN
4224@cindex HIDDEN
4225For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4226exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4227
4228Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4229@code{HIDDEN}:
4230
4231@smallexample
4232HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4233SECTIONS
4234@{
4235 .text :
4236 @{
4237 *(.text)
4238 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4239 @}
4240 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4241 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4242@}
4243@end smallexample
4244@noindent
4245In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4246
252b5132
RH
4247@node PROVIDE
4248@subsection PROVIDE
4249@cindex PROVIDE
4250In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4251only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4252the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4253@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4254@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4255@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4256@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4257@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4258
4259Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4260@smallexample
4261SECTIONS
4262@{
4263 .text :
4264 @{
4265 *(.text)
4266 _etext = .;
4267 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4268 @}
4269@}
4270@end smallexample
4271
4272In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4273underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4274the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4275underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4276If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4277linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4278
b0daac83
NC
4279Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4280defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4281that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4282when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4283@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4284
7af8e998
L
4285@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4286@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4287@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4288Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4289hidden and won't be exported.
4290
73ae6183
NC
4291@node Source Code Reference
4292@subsection Source Code Reference
4293
4294Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4295intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4296a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4297symbol that does not have a value.
4298
4299Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4300transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4301stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4302prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4303mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4304of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4305variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4306linker script variable might be referred to as:
4307
4308@smallexample
4309 extern int foo;
4310@end smallexample
4311
4312But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4313
4314@smallexample
4315 _foo = 1000;
4316@end smallexample
4317
4318In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4319transformation has taken place.
4320
4321When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4322things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4323in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4324second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4325table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4326contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4327value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4328
4329@smallexample
4330 int foo = 1000;
4331@end smallexample
4332
10bf6894 4333creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4334holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4335number 1000 is initially stored.
4336
4337When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4338first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4339memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4340So:
4341
4342@smallexample
4343 foo = 1;
4344@end smallexample
4345
4346looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4347associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4348address. Whereas:
4349
4350@smallexample
4351 int * a = & foo;
4352@end smallexample
4353
10bf6894 4354looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4355and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4356the variable @samp{a}.
4357
4358Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4359the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4360an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4361
4362@smallexample
4363 foo = 1000;
4364@end smallexample
4365
4366creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4367the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4368address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4369linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4370access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4371
4372Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4373you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4374use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4375section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4376linker script contains these declarations:
4377
4378@smallexample
4379@group
4380 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4381 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4382 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4383@end group
4384@end smallexample
4385
4386Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4387
4388@smallexample
4389@group
4390 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4391
73ae6183
NC
4392 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4393@end group
4394@end smallexample
4395
4396Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4397Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4398arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4399
4400@smallexample
4401@group
4402 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4403
4404 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4405@end group
4406@end smallexample
4407
4408Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4409operators.
73ae6183 4410
252b5132 4411@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4412@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4413@kindex SECTIONS
4414The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4415into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4416
4417The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4418@smallexample
4419SECTIONS
4420@{
4421 @var{sections-command}
4422 @var{sections-command}
4423 @dots{}
4424@}
4425@end smallexample
4426
4427Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4428
4429@itemize @bullet
4430@item
4431an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4432@item
4433a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4434@item
4435an output section description
4436@item
4437an overlay description
4438@end itemize
4439
4440The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4441@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4442those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4443understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4444the layout of the output file.
4445
4446Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4447below.
4448
4449If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4450linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4451section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4452input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4453example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4454in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4455
4456@menu
4457* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4458* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4459* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4460* Input Section:: Input section description
4461* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4462* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4463* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4464* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4465* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4466@end menu
4467
4468@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4469@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4470The full description of an output section looks like this:
4471@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4472@group
7e7d5768 4473@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4474 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4475 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4476 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4477 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4478 @{
4479 @var{output-section-command}
4480 @var{output-section-command}
4481 @dots{}
abc9061b 4482 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4483@end group
4484@end smallexample
4485
4486Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4487
4488The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4489name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4490The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4491the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4492The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4493
4494Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4495
4496@itemize @bullet
4497@item
4498a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4499@item
4500an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4501@item
4502data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4503@item
4504a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4505@end itemize
4506
4507@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4508@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4509@cindex name, section
4510@cindex section name
4511The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4512meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4513support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4514must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4515example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4516output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4517names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4518quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4519characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4520commas must be quoted.
4521
4522The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4523Discarding}.
4524
4525@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4526@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4527@cindex address, section
4528@cindex section address
4529The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4530address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4531is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4532
4533If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4534section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4535to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4536alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4537contained within the output section.
4538
4539The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4540
4541@itemize @bullet
4542@item
4543If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4544is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4545in that region.
4546
4547@item
4548If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4549regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4550section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4551be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4552
4553@item
4554If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4555the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4556counter.
4557@end itemize
4558
4559@noindent
4560For example:
4561
252b5132
RH
4562@smallexample
4563.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4564@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4565
252b5132
RH
4566@noindent
4567and
ea5cae92 4568
252b5132
RH
4569@smallexample
4570.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4571@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4572
252b5132
RH
4573@noindent
4574are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4575@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4576counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4577counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4578input sections.
252b5132
RH
4579
4580The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4581For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4582so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4583do something like this:
4584@smallexample
4585.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4586@end smallexample
4587@noindent
4588This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4589aligned upward to the specified value.
4590
4591Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4592location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4593sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4594
4595@node Input Section
36f63dca 4596@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4597@cindex input sections
4598@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4599The most common output section command is an input section description.
4600
4601The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4602You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4603in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4604map the input files into your memory layout.
4605
4606@menu
4607* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4608* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4609* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4610* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4611* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4612@end menu
4613
4614@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4615@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4616@cindex input section basics
4617An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4618by a list of section names in parentheses.
4619
4620The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4621describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4622
4623The most common input section description is to include all input
4624sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4625include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4626@smallexample
4627*(.text)
4628@end smallexample
4629@noindent
18625d54 4630Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4631@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4632of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4633match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4634example:
252b5132 4635@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4636EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4637@end smallexample
4638@noindent
4639will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4640and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4641placed inside the section list, for example:
4642@smallexample
b4346c09 4643*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4644@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4645@noindent
4646The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4647two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4648more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4649
4650There are two ways to include more than one section:
4651@smallexample
4652*(.text .rdata)
4653*(.text) *(.rdata)
4654@end smallexample
4655@noindent
4656The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4657@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4658first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4659they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4660@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4661@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4662
8f1732fc
AB
4663When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4664is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4665immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4666@smallexample
4667*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4668@end smallexample
4669@noindent
4670will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4671@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4672from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4673exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4674could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4675@smallexample
4676*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4677@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4678@noindent
4679Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4680before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4681all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4682@smallexample
4683EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4684@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4685
252b5132
RH
4686You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4687You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4688needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4689@smallexample
4690data.o(.data)
4691@end smallexample
4692
ae17ab41
CM
4693To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4694of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4695
4696Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4697
4698@smallexample
4699@group
4700SECTIONS @{
4701 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4702 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4703@}
4704@end group
4705@end smallexample
4706
4707In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4708input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4709@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4710@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4711whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4712
967928e9
AM
4713You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4714matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4715with no whitespace around the colon.
4716
4717@table @samp
4718@item archive:file
4719matches file within archive
4720@item archive:
4721matches the whole archive
4722@item :file
4723matches file but not one in an archive
4724@end table
4725
4726Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4727wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4728single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4729@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4730within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4731also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4732other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4733from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4734command.
4735
252b5132
RH
4736If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4737the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4738commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4739@smallexample
4740data.o
4741@end smallexample
4742
967928e9
AM
4743When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4744and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4745characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4746name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4747did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4748though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4749@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4750the archive search path.
4751
4752@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4753@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4754@cindex input section wildcards
4755@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4756@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4757@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4758In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4759name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4760
4761The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4762pattern for the file name.
4763
4764The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4765
4766@table @samp
4767@item *
4768matches any number of characters
4769@item ?
4770matches any single character
4771@item [@var{chars}]
4772matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4773character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4774@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4775@item \
4776quotes the following character
4777@end table
4778
4779When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4780will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4781Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4782exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4783@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4784a @samp{/} character.
4785
4786File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4787specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4788does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4789
4790If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4791appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4792will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4793sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4794@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4795@smallexample
4796.data : @{ *(.data) @}
4797.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4798@end smallexample
4799
bcaa7b3e 4800@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
4801Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4802in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
4803this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4804pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4805@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
4806into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4807
bcaa7b3e 4808@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
4809@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4810@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4811alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4812alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4813needed.
bcaa7b3e 4814
02ecc8e9 4815@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
4816@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4817@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4818numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4819section name before placing them in the output file. In
4820@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4821the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4822@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 4823
bcaa7b3e
L
4824@cindex SORT
4825@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4826
4827When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
4828can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
4829
4830@enumerate
4831@item
4832@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4833It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4834sections have the same name.
4835@item
4836@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4837It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4838sections have the same alignment.
4839@item
c0065db7 4840@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
4841treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
4842@item
4843@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
4844is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
4845@item
4846All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
4847@end enumerate
4848
a05a5b64 4849When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 4850section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 4851takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
4852
4853If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 4854command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
4855treated as nested sorting command.
4856
4857@enumerate
4858@item
4859@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
4860@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
4861@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4862@item
4863@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
4864@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
4865@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4866@end enumerate
4867
4868If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 4869command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 4870
eda680f8 4871@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 4872@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
4873section sorting option.
4874
252b5132
RH
4875If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
4876@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
4877precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
4878
4879This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
4880files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
4881sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
4882The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
4883with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
4884linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
4885@smallexample
4886@group
4887SECTIONS @{
4888 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4889 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
4890 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4891 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4892@}
4893@end group
4894@end smallexample
4895
4896@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 4897@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
4898@cindex common symbol placement
4899@cindex uninitialized data placement
4900A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
4901file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
4902linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
4903named @samp{COMMON}.
4904
4905You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
4906other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
4907particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
4908input files are placed in another section.
4909
4910In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
4911@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
4912@smallexample
4913.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
4914@end smallexample
4915
4916@cindex scommon section
4917@cindex small common symbols
4918Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
4919example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
4920symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
4921different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
4922the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
4923symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
4924to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
4925locations.
4926
4927@cindex [COMMON]
4928You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
4929notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
4930@samp{*(COMMON)}.
4931
4932@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 4933@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
4934@cindex KEEP
4935@cindex garbage collection
4936When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 4937it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
4938This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
4939with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 4940@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
4941
4942@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 4943@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
4944The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
4945to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
4946start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
4947@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
4948follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
4949@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
4950@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
4951All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
4952files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
4953
4954@smallexample
4955@group
4956SECTIONS @{
4957 outputa 0x10000 :
4958 @{
4959 all.o
4960 foo.o (.input1)
4961 @}
36f63dca
NC
4962@end group
4963@group
252b5132
RH
4964 outputb :
4965 @{
4966 foo.o (.input2)
4967 foo1.o (.input1)
4968 @}
36f63dca
NC
4969@end group
4970@group
252b5132
RH
4971 outputc :
4972 @{
4973 *(.input1)
4974 *(.input2)
4975 @}
4976@}
4977@end group
a1ab1d2a 4978@end smallexample
252b5132 4979
cbd0eecf
L
4980If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
4981and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
4982automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
4983__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
4984indicate the start address and end address of the output section
4985respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
4986C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
4987
252b5132 4988@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 4989@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
4990@cindex data
4991@cindex section data
4992@cindex output section data
4993@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
4994@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
4995@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
4996@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
4997@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
4998You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
4999@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5000an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5001parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5002value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5003counter.
5004
5005The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5006store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5007bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5008stored.
5009
5010For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5011of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5012@smallexample
5013BYTE(1)
5014LONG(addr)
5015@end smallexample
5016
5017When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5018same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5019target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5020@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5021@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5022
5023If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5024which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5025When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5026true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5027endianness of the first input object file.
5028
36f63dca 5029Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5030between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5031@smallexample
5032SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5033@end smallexample
5034whereas this will work:
5035@smallexample
5036SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5037@end smallexample
5038
252b5132
RH
5039@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5040@cindex holes, filling
5041@cindex unspecified memory
5042You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5043current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5044otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5045gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5046with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5047necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5048point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5049than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5050different parts of an output section.
5051
5052This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5053value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5054@smallexample
563e308f 5055FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5056@end smallexample
5057
5058The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5059section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5060part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5061entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5062precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5063expression.
252b5132
RH
5064
5065@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5066@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5067There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5068commands.
5069
5070@table @code
5071@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5072@cindex input filename symbols
5073@cindex filename symbols
5074@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5075The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5076The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5077file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5078the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5079
5080This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5081normally used for any other object file format.
5082
5083@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5084@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5085@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5086@item CONSTRUCTORS
5087When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5088unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5089destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5090arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5091automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5092For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5093linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5094@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5095ignored for other object file formats.
5096
5097The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5098constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5099Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5100the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5101first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5102of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5103compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5104formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5105@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5106the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5107destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5108@code{exit}.
5109
5110For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5111arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5112addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5113and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5114linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5115runtime code expects to see.
5116
5117@smallexample
5118 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5119 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5120 *(.ctors)
5121 LONG(0)
5122 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5123 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5124 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5125 *(.dtors)
5126 LONG(0)
5127 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5128@end smallexample
5129
5130If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5131which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5132are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5133are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5134command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5135@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5136@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5137@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5138
5139Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5140and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5141need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5142scripts.
5143
5144@end table
5145
5146@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5147@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5148@cindex discarding sections
5149@cindex sections, discarding
5150@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5151The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5152This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5153may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5154@smallexample
49c13adb 5155.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5156@end smallexample
5157@noindent
5158will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5159@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5160sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5161space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5162too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5163space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5164@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5165@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5166This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5167
a0976ea4 5168The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5169on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5170symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5171the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5172section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5173
5174@cindex /DISCARD/
5175The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5176input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5177section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5178
a2e098c3
NC
5179Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5180discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5181members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5182Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5183
252b5132 5184@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5185@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5186@cindex output section attributes
5187We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5188like this:
0c71d759 5189
252b5132 5190@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5191@group
7e7d5768 5192@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5193 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5194 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5195 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5196 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5197 @{
5198 @var{output-section-command}
5199 @var{output-section-command}
5200 @dots{}
562d3460 5201 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5202@end group
5203@end smallexample
0c71d759 5204
252b5132
RH
5205We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5206@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5207remaining section attributes.
5208
a1ab1d2a 5209@menu
252b5132
RH
5210* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5211* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5212* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5213* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5214* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5215* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5216* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5217* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5218@end menu
5219
5220@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5221@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5222Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5223parentheses. The following types are defined:
5224
5225@table @code
5226@item NOLOAD
5227The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5228loaded into memory when the program is run.
5229@item DSECT
5230@itemx COPY
5231@itemx INFO
5232@itemx OVERLAY
5233These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5234rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5235marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5236section when the program is run.
5237@end table
5238
5239@kindex NOLOAD
5240@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5241@cindex loading, preventing
5242The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5243the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5244the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5245@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5246need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5247@smallexample
5248@group
5249SECTIONS @{
5250 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5251 @dots{}
5252@}
5253@end group
5254@end smallexample
5255
5256@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5257@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5258@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5259@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5260@cindex load address
5261@cindex section load address
5262Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5263@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5264@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5265specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5266address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5267
ea5cae92
NC
5268The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5269specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5270takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5271load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5272region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5273
5274If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5275section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5276load address:
5277
5278@itemize @bullet
5279@item
5280If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5281the LMA address as well.
5282
5283@item
5284If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5285
5286@item
5287Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5288with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5289section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5290VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5291the last section in the located region.
5292
5293@item
5294If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5295that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5296
5297@item
5298If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5299section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5300@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5301
5302@cindex ROM initialized data
5303@cindex initialized data in ROM
5304This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5305example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5306called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5307@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5308even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5309uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5310defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5311counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5312
5313@smallexample
5314@group
5315SECTIONS
5316 @{
5317 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5318 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5319 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5320 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5321 .bss 0x3000 :
5322 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5323@}
5324@end group
5325@end smallexample
5326
5327The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5328this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5329the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5330how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5331script.
5332
5333@smallexample
5334@group
5335extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5336char *src = &_etext;
5337char *dst = &_data;
5338
ea5cae92
NC
5339/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5340while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5341 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5342
ea5cae92 5343/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5344for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5345 *dst = 0;
5346@end group
5347@end smallexample
5348
bbf115d3
L
5349@node Forced Output Alignment
5350@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5351@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5352@cindex forcing output section alignment
5353@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5354You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5355alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5356intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5357
7e7d5768
AM
5358@node Forced Input Alignment
5359@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5360@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5361@cindex forcing input section alignment
5362@cindex input section alignment
5363You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5364SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5365sections, whether larger or smaller.
5366
0c71d759
NC
5367@node Output Section Constraint
5368@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5369@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5370@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5371@cindex constraints on output sections
5372You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5373of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5374read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5375@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5376
252b5132 5377@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5378@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5379@kindex >@var{region}
5380@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5381@cindex memory regions and sections
5382You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5383using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5384
5385Here is a simple example:
5386@smallexample
5387@group
5388MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5389SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5390@end group
5391@end smallexample
5392
5393@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5394@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5395@kindex :@var{phdr}
5396@cindex section, assigning to program header
5397@cindex program headers and sections
5398You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5399using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5400one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5401assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5402@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5403linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5404
5405Here is a simple example:
5406@smallexample
5407@group
5408PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5409SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5410@end group
5411@end smallexample
5412
5413@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5414@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5415@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5416@cindex section fill pattern
5417@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5418You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5419@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5420(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5421within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5422alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5423necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5424of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5425an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5426fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5427other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5428pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5429expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5430
5431You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5432output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5433
5434Here is a simple example:
5435@smallexample
5436@group
563e308f 5437SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5438@end group
5439@end smallexample
5440
5441@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5442@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5443@kindex OVERLAY
5444@cindex overlays
5445An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5446are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5447the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5448copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5449required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5450can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5451than another.
5452
5453Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5454@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5455output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5456command is as follows:
5457@smallexample
5458@group
5459OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5460 @{
5461 @var{secname1}
5462 @{
5463 @var{output-section-command}
5464 @var{output-section-command}
5465 @dots{}
5466 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5467 @var{secname2}
5468 @{
5469 @var{output-section-command}
5470 @var{output-section-command}
5471 @dots{}
5472 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5473 @dots{}
abc9061b 5474 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5475@end group
5476@end smallexample
5477
5478Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5479section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5480section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5481those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5482except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5483sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5484
abc9061b
CC
5485The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5486the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5487
252b5132
RH
5488The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5489addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5490memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5491whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5492and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5493and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5494
56dd11f0
NC
5495If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5496references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5497the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5498sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5499@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5500
5501For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5502provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5503defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5504@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5505the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5506within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5507symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5508
5509At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5510the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5511
5512Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5513@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5514@smallexample
5515@group
5516 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5517 @{
5518 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5519 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5520 @}
5521@end group
5522@end smallexample
5523@noindent
5524This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5525address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5526@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5527following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5528@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5529@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5530
5531C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5532like the following.
5533
5534@smallexample
5535@group
5536 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5537 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5538 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5539@end group
5540@end smallexample
5541
5542Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5543everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5544example could have been written identically as follows.
5545
5546@smallexample
5547@group
5548 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5549 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5550 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5551 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5552 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5553 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5554 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5555@end group
5556@end smallexample
5557
5558@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5559@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5560@kindex MEMORY
5561@cindex memory regions
5562@cindex regions of memory
5563@cindex allocating memory
5564@cindex discontinuous memory
5565The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5566memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5567
5568The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5569memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5570may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5571can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5572set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5573regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5574around to fit into the available regions.
5575
127fcdff
AB
5576A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5577however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5578specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5579@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5580@smallexample
5581@group
a1ab1d2a 5582MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5583 @{
5584 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5585 @dots{}
5586 @}
5587@end group
5588@end smallexample
5589
5590The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5591region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5592Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5593with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5594must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5595add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5596command.
252b5132
RH
5597
5598@cindex memory region attributes
5599The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5600whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5601not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5602@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5603section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5604the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5605them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5606
5607The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5608@table @samp
5609@item R
5610Read-only section
5611@item W
5612Read/write section
5613@item X
5614Executable section
5615@item A
5616Allocatable section
5617@item I
5618Initialized section
5619@item L
5620Same as @samp{I}
5621@item !
c09e9a8c 5622Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5623@end table
5624
81c688d5 5625If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5626@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5627attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5628unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5629not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5630string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5631or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5632the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5633
5634@kindex ORIGIN =
5635@kindex o =
5636@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5637The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5638the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5639cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5640abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5641@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5642
5643@kindex LENGTH =
5644@kindex len =
5645@kindex l =
5646The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5647region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5648be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5649@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5650
5651In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5652available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5653and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5654linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5655is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5656or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5657explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5658region.
5659
5660@smallexample
5661@group
a1ab1d2a 5662MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5663 @{
5664 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5665 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5666 @}
5667@end group
5668@end smallexample
5669
5670Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5671specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5672@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5673a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5674output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5675was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5676the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5677output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5678region, the linker will issue an error message.
5679
3ec57632 5680It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5681expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5682@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5683
5684@smallexample
5685@group
c0065db7 5686 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5687@end group
5688@end smallexample
5689
252b5132
RH
5690@node PHDRS
5691@section PHDRS Command
5692@kindex PHDRS
5693@cindex program headers
5694@cindex ELF program headers
5695@cindex program segments
5696@cindex segments, ELF
5697The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5698@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5699loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5700program with the @samp{-p} option.
5701
5702When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5703reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5704program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5705This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5706interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5707
5708The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5709in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5710precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5711the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5712not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5713
5714The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5715generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5716ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5717
5718This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5719@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5720
5721@smallexample
5722@group
5723PHDRS
5724@{
5725 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5726 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5727@}
5728@end group
5729@end smallexample
5730
5731The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5732of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5733header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5734with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5735must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5736is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5737
5738Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5739system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5740specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5741sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5742attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5743Section Phdr}.
5744
5745It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5746merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5747repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5748contain the section.
5749
5750If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5751then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5752not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5753convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5754placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5755default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5756segment at all.
5757
5758@kindex FILEHDR
5759@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5760You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5761the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5762The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5763file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5764include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5765segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5766these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5767
5768The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5769value of the keyword.
5770
5771@table @asis
5772@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5773Indicates an unused program header.
5774
5775@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5776Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5777the file.
5778
5779@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5780Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5781
5782@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5783Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5784found.
5785
5786@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5787Indicates a segment holding note information.
5788
5789@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5790A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5791ABI.
5792
5793@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5794Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5795
1a9ccd70
NC
5796@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5797Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5798
252b5132
RH
5799@item @var{expression}
5800An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5801be used for types not defined above.
5802@end table
5803
5804You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5805in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5806@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5807Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5808output section attribute.
5809
5810The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5811which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5812explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5813an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5814header.
5815
5816Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5817headers used on a native ELF system.
5818
5819@example
5820@group
5821PHDRS
5822@{
5823 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
5824 interp PT_INTERP ;
5825 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
5826 data PT_LOAD ;
5827 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
5828@}
5829
5830SECTIONS
5831@{
5832 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
5833 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
5834 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
5835 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
5836 @dots{}
5837 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
5838 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
5839 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
5840 @dots{}
5841@}
5842@end group
5843@end example
5844
5845@node VERSION
5846@section VERSION Command
5847@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
5848@cindex symbol versions
5849@cindex version script
5850@cindex versions of symbols
5851The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
5852only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
5853symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
5854a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
5855shared library.
5856
5857You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
5858you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
5859also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
5860
5861The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
5862@smallexample
5863VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
5864@end smallexample
5865
5866The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
5867Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
5868version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
5869version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
5870version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
5871scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
5872library.
5873
5874The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
5875examples.
5876
5877@smallexample
5878VERS_1.1 @{
5879 global:
5880 foo1;
5881 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
5882 old*;
5883 original*;
5884 new*;
252b5132
RH
5885@};
5886
5887VERS_1.2 @{
5888 foo2;
5889@} VERS_1.1;
5890
5891VERS_2.0 @{
5892 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 5893 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 5894 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
5895 "f(int, double)";
5896 @};
252b5132
RH
5897@} VERS_1.2;
5898@end smallexample
5899
5900This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
5901version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
5902The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
5903a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
5904of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
5905symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
5906is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
5907in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
5908However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
5909name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
5910
5911Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
5912depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
5913to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
5914
5915Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
5916depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
5917and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
5918
5919When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
5920specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
5921unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 5922unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
5923somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
5924wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
5925wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
5926set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
5927ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
5928
5929The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
5930they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
5931could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
5932However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
5933
0f6bf451 5934Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
5935in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
5936symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
5937won't.
5938
5939@smallexample
7c9c73be 5940@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 5941@end smallexample
6b9b879a 5942
252b5132
RH
5943When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
5944symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
5945requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
5946shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
5947loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
5948linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
5949application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
5950way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
5951all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
5952search for each symbol reference.
5953
5954The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
5955doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
5956that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
5957functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
5958the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
5959required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
5960that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
5961versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
5962the libraries being used with the application are too old.
5963
5964There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
5965first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
5966source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
5967script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
5968maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
5969@smallexample
5970__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
5971@end smallexample
5972@noindent
5973in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
5974be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
5975The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
5976@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
5977takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
5978
5979The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
5980function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
5981an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
5982version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
5983linked against the old interface to continue to function.
5984
5985To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
5986source file. Here is an example:
5987
5988@smallexample
5989__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
5990__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
5991__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
5992__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
5993@end smallexample
5994
5995In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
5996unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
5997example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
5998@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
5999
6000When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6001some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6002this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6003@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6004declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6005you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6006
6007If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6008within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6009(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6010specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6011
cb840a31
L
6012You can also specify the language in the version script:
6013
6014@smallexample
6015VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6016@end smallexample
6017
c0065db7 6018The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6019The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6020demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6021patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6022@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6023
86043bbb
MM
6024Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6025described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6026or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6027the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6028whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6029cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6030might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6031should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6032expect when you upgrade.
6033
252b5132
RH
6034@node Expressions
6035@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6036@cindex expressions
6037@cindex arithmetic
6038The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6039that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6040expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6041host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6042
6043You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6044
6045The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6046expressions.
6047
6048@menu
6049* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6050* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6051* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6052* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6053* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6054* Operators:: Operators
6055* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6056* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6057* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6058@end menu
6059
6060@node Constants
6061@subsection Constants
6062@cindex integer notation
6063@cindex constants in linker scripts
6064All constants are integers.
6065
6066As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6067octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6068hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6069@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6070@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6071value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6072
6073@cindex scaled integers
6074@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6075@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6076@cindex suffixes for integers
6077@cindex integer suffixes
6078In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6079constant by
6080@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6081@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6082@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6083@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6084@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6085@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6086@tex
6087${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6088@end tex
6089@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6090respectively. For example, the following
6091all refer to the same quantity:
6092
252b5132 6093@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6094_fourk_1 = 4K;
6095_fourk_2 = 4096;
6096_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6097_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6098@end smallexample
6099
8a308ae8
NC
6100Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6101conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6102
0c71d759
NC
6103@node Symbolic Constants
6104@subsection Symbolic Constants
6105@cindex symbolic constants
6106@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6107It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6108the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6109
6110@table @code
6111@item MAXPAGESIZE
6112@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6113The target's maximum page size.
6114
6115@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6116@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6117The target's default page size.
6118@end table
6119
6120So for example:
6121
6122@smallexample
9d5777a3 6123 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6124@end smallexample
6125
6126will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6127supported by the target.
6128
252b5132
RH
6129@node Symbols
6130@subsection Symbol Names
6131@cindex symbol names
6132@cindex names
6133@cindex quoted symbol names
6134@kindex "
6135Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6136and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6137Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6138specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6139keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6140@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6141"SECTION" = 9;
6142"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6143@end smallexample
6144
6145Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6146to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6147whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6148
ecca9871
L
6149@node Orphan Sections
6150@subsection Orphan Sections
6151@cindex orphan
6152Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6153are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6154script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6155output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6156in which to place the orphaned input section.
6157
6158If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6159an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6160placed at the end of that output section.
6161
6162If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6163sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6164name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6165orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6166one new output section.
6167
6168If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6169then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6170in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6171linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6172attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6173sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6174support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6175
a05a5b64
TP
6176The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6177(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6178output sections an orphan is placed in.
6179
252b5132
RH
6180@node Location Counter
6181@subsection The Location Counter
6182@kindex .
6183@cindex dot
6184@cindex location counter
6185@cindex current output location
6186The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6187current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6188location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6189within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6190anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6191
6192@cindex holes
6193Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6194moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6195location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6196and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6197doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6198
6199@smallexample
6200SECTIONS
6201@{
6202 output :
6203 @{
6204 file1(.text)
6205 . = . + 1000;
6206 file2(.text)
6207 . += 1000;
6208 file3(.text)
563e308f 6209 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6210@}
6211@end smallexample
6212@noindent
6213In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6214located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6215followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6216@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6217@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6218specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6219
5c6bbab8
NC
6220@cindex dot inside sections
6221Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6222current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6223statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6224absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6225however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6226not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6227
6228@smallexample
6229SECTIONS
6230@{
6231 . = 0x100
6232 .text: @{
6233 *(.text)
6234 . = 0x200
6235 @}
6236 . = 0x500
6237 .data: @{
6238 *(.data)
6239 . += 0x600
6240 @}
6241@}
6242@end smallexample
6243
6244The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6245and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6246the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6247much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6248move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6249and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6250the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6251the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6252
b5666f2f
AM
6253@cindex dot outside sections
6254Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6255output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6256needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6257
6258@smallexample
6259SECTIONS
6260@{
6261 start_of_text = . ;
6262 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6263 end_of_text = . ;
6264
6265 start_of_data = . ;
6266 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6267 end_of_data = . ;
6268@}
6269@end smallexample
6270
6271If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6272not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6273between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6274should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6275blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6276the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6277sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6278statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6279special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6280place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6281as follows:
6282
6283@smallexample
6284SECTIONS
6285@{
6286 start_of_text = . ;
6287 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6288 end_of_text = . ;
6289
6290 start_of_data = . ;
6291 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6292 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6293 end_of_data = . ;
6294@}
6295@end smallexample
6296
6297This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6298@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6299placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6300assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6301a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6302section. So you could write:
6303
6304@smallexample
6305SECTIONS
6306@{
6307 start_of_text = . ;
6308 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6309 end_of_text = . ;
6310
6311 . = . ;
6312 start_of_data = . ;
6313 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6314 end_of_data = . ;
6315@}
6316@end smallexample
6317
6318Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6319@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6320
252b5132
RH
6321@need 2000
6322@node Operators
6323@subsection Operators
6324@cindex operators for arithmetic
6325@cindex arithmetic operators
6326@cindex precedence in expressions
6327The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6328the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6329@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6330@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6331@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6332@smallexample
6333precedence associativity Operators Notes
6334(highest)
63351 left ! - ~ (1)
63362 left * / %
63373 left + -
63384 left >> <<
63395 left == != > < <= >=
63406 left &
63417 left |
63428 left &&
63439 left ||
634410 right ? :
634511 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6346(lowest)
6347@end smallexample
6348Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6349(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6350(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6351@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6352@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6353@tex
6354\vskip \baselineskip
6355%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6356\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6357\hrule
6358\halign
6359{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6360height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6361&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6362height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6363\noalign{\hrule}
6364height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6365&highest&&&&&\cr
6366% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6367&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6368&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6369&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6370&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6371&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6372&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6373&7&&left&&|&\cr
6374&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6375&9&&left&&||&\cr
6376&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6377&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6378&lowest&&&&&\cr
6379height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6380\hrule}
6381@end tex
6382@iftex
6383{
6384@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6385@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6386@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6387}
6388@end iftex
6389@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6390
6391@node Evaluation
6392@subsection Evaluation
6393@cindex lazy evaluation
6394@cindex expression evaluation order
6395The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6396an expression when absolutely necessary.
6397
6398The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6399address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6400regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6401as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6402
6403However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6404until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6405other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6406for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6407
6408The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6409assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6410allocation.
6411
6412Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6413@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6414
6415If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6416available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6417following
6418@smallexample
6419@group
6420SECTIONS
6421 @{
a1ab1d2a 6422 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6423 @{ *(.text) @}
6424 @}
6425@end group
6426@end smallexample
6427@noindent
6428will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6429address}.
6430
6431@node Expression Section
6432@subsection The Section of an Expression
6433@cindex expression sections
6434@cindex absolute expressions
6435@cindex relative expressions
6436@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6437@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6438@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6439Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6440relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6441using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6442value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6443symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6444operations.
6445
abf4be64
AM
6446Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6447section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6448address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6449@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6450functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6451One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6452(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6453differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6454versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6455section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6456Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6457absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6458given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6459everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6460
6461In the following simple example,
252b5132 6462
7542af2a
AM
6463@smallexample
6464@group
6465SECTIONS
6466 @{
6467 . = 0x100;
6468 __executable_start = 0x100;
6469 .data :
6470 @{
6471 . = 0x10;
6472 __data_start = 0x10;
6473 *(.data)
6474 @}
6475 @dots{}
6476 @}
6477@end group
6478@end smallexample
252b5132 6479
7542af2a
AM
6480both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6481address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6482@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6483section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6484
5c3049d2
AM
6485For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6486addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6487
6488@itemize @bullet
6489@item
c05f749e
AM
6490Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6491operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6492absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6493@item
7542af2a
AM
6494Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6495relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6496and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6497@item
c05f749e
AM
6498Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6499in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6500address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6501before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6502@end itemize
6503
6504The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6505
6506@itemize @bullet
6507@item
6508An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6509@item
6510The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6511@item
9bc8bb33 6512The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6513relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6514(after above conversions) is also a number when
6515@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6516but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6517@item
6518The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6519relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6520section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6521@item
6522The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6523conversions) is an absolute address.
6524@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6525
6526You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6527to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6528create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6529section @samp{.data}:
6530@smallexample
6531SECTIONS
6532 @{
6533 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6534 @}
6535@end smallexample
6536@noindent
6537If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6538@samp{.data} section.
6539
7542af2a
AM
6540Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6541particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6542
252b5132
RH
6543@node Builtin Functions
6544@subsection Builtin Functions
6545@cindex functions in expressions
6546The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6547use in linker script expressions.
6548
6549@table @code
6550@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6551@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6552@cindex expression, absolute
6553Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6554of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6555value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6556normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6557
6558@item ADDR(@var{section})
6559@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6560@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6561Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6562script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6563the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6564@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6565@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6566the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6567@smallexample
6568@group
6569SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6570 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6571 @{
252b5132
RH
6572 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6573 @dots{}
6574 @}
6575 .output :
6576 @{
6577 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6578 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6579 @}
6580@dots{} @}
6581@end group
6582@end smallexample
6583
876f4090
NS
6584@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6585@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6586@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6587@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6588@cindex round up location counter
6589@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6590@cindex round up expression
6591@cindex align expression
6592Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6593to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6594doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6595arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6596expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6597equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6598
6599Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6600next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6601variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6602input sections:
252b5132
RH
6603@smallexample
6604@group
6605SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6606 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6607 *(.data)
6608 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6609 @}
6610@dots{} @}
6611@end group
6612@end smallexample
6613@noindent
6614The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6615a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6616a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6617of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6618
6619The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6620
362c1d1a
NS
6621@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6622@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6623@cindex section alignment
6624Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6625been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6626evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6627the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6628value in that section.
6629@smallexample
6630@group
6631SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6632 .output @{
6633 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6634 @dots{}
6635 @}
6636@dots{} @}
6637@end group
6638@end smallexample
6639
252b5132
RH
6640@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6641@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6642This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6643scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6644section.
6645
2d20f7bf
JJ
6646@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6647@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6648This is equivalent to either
6649@smallexample
6650(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6651@end smallexample
6652or
6653@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6654(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6655 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6656@end smallexample
6657@noindent
6658depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6659for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6660@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6661If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6662memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6663bytes in the on-disk file.
6664
6665This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6666any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6667@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6668be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6669running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6670that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6671page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6672
6673@noindent
6674Example:
6675@smallexample
6676 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6677@end smallexample
6678
6679@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6680@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6681This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6682evaluation purposes.
6683
6684@smallexample
6685 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6686@end smallexample
6687
a4f5ad88
JJ
6688@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6689@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6690This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6691@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6692When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6693does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6694@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6695argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6696script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6697@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6698padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6699section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6700
6701@smallexample
6702 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6703@end smallexample
6704
252b5132
RH
6705@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6706@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6707@cindex symbol defaults
6708Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6709defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6710return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6711default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6712shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6713the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6714existed, its value is preserved:
6715
6716@smallexample
6717@group
6718SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6719 .text : @{
6720 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6721 @dots{}
6722 @}
6723 @dots{}
6724@}
6725@end group
6726@end smallexample
6727
3ec57632
NC
6728@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6729@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6730Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6731
252b5132
RH
6732@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6733@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6734@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6735Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6736Section LMA}).
6737
2e53f7d6
NC
6738@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6739@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6740Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6741@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6742
252b5132
RH
6743@kindex MAX
6744@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6745Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6746
6747@kindex MIN
6748@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6749Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6750
6751@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6752@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6753@cindex unallocated address, next
6754Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6755This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6756use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6757output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6758
3ec57632
NC
6759@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6760@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6761Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6762
ba916c8a
MM
6763@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6764@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6765Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6766value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6767@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6768will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6769can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 6770``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
6771name.
6772
252b5132
RH
6773@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6774@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6775@cindex section size
6776Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6777been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6778evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6779@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6780@smallexample
6781@group
6782SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6783 .output @{
6784 .start = . ;
6785 @dots{}
6786 .end = . ;
6787 @}
6788 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6789 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6790@dots{} @}
6791@end group
6792@end smallexample
6793
6794@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6795@itemx sizeof_headers
6796@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6797@cindex header size
6798Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6799information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6800this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6801choose, to facilitate paging.
6802
6803@cindex not enough room for program headers
6804@cindex program headers, not enough room
6805When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6806@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6807number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6808addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6809additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6810room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6811the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6812script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6813you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6814command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6815@end table
6816
6817@node Implicit Linker Scripts
6818@section Implicit Linker Scripts
6819@cindex implicit linker scripts
6820If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
6821an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
6822linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
6823linker will report an error.
6824
6825An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
6826
6827Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
6828assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
6829commands.
6830
6831Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
6832at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
6833read. This can affect archive searching.
6834
6835@ifset GENERIC
6836@node Machine Dependent
6837@chapter Machine Dependent Features
6838
6839@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
6840@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
6841sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
6842functionality are not listed.
6843
6844@menu
36f63dca
NC
6845@ifset H8300
6846* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
6847@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
6848@ifset M68HC11
6849* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
6850@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
6851@ifset ARM
6852* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
6853@end ifset
6854@ifset HPPA
6855* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
6856@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
6857@ifset M68K
6858* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
6859@end ifset
833794fc
MR
6860@ifset MIPS
6861* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
6862@end ifset
3c3bdf30 6863@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 6864* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 6865@end ifset
2469cfa2 6866@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 6867* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 6868@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
6869@ifset NDS32
6870* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
6871@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
6872@ifset NIOSII
6873* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
6874@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
6875@ifset POWERPC
6876* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
6877@end ifset
6878@ifset POWERPC64
6879* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
6880@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
6881@ifset S/390
6882* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
6883@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
6884@ifset SPU
6885* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
6886@end ifset
74459f0e 6887@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 6888* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 6889@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
6890@ifset WIN32
6891* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
6892@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
6893@ifset XTENSA
6894* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
6895@end ifset
252b5132
RH
6896@end menu
6897@end ifset
6898
252b5132
RH
6899@ifset H8300
6900@ifclear GENERIC
6901@raisesections
6902@end ifclear
6903
6904@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 6905@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
6906
6907@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 6908For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
6909you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
6910
6911@table @emph
6912@cindex relaxing on H8/300
6913@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 6914@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
6915targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
6916program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
6917respectively.
6918
6919@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
6920@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 6921@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 6922@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
6923sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
6924page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
6925(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
6926@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
6927top page of memory).
1502569c 6928
81f5558e
NC
6929@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
6930indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
6931displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
6932the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
6933@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
6934whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
6935range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
6936
1502569c 6937@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 6938@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 6939biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 6940which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
6941page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
6942(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 6943@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
6944the top page of memory).
6945
6946@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
6947@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
694832 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
6949changes them to use 16 bit address form.
6950(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 6951@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 6952the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
6953@end table
6954
6955@ifclear GENERIC
6956@lowersections
6957@end ifclear
6958@end ifset
6959
36f63dca 6960@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 6961@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 6962@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
6963@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
6964@node Renesas
6965@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 6966
c2dcd04e
NC
6967@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
6968H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
6969options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
6970@end ifset
6971@end ifclear
6972
36f63dca
NC
6973@ifset ARM
6974@ifclear GENERIC
6975@raisesections
6976@end ifclear
6977
93fd0973
SC
6978@ifset M68HC11
6979@ifclear GENERIC
6980@raisesections
6981@end ifclear
6982
6983@node M68HC11/68HC12
6984@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
6985
6986@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
6987
6988@subsection Linker Relaxation
6989
6990For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
6991optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
6992
6993@table @emph
6994@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
6995@item relaxing address modes
6996@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
6997targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
6998program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
6999respectively.
7000
7001@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7002transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7003page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7004
7005@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7006When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7007of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7008addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7009@code{bset} instructions.
7010
7011@end table
7012
7013@subsection Trampoline Generation
7014
7015@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7016@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7017For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7018call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7019will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7020trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7021case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7022point to the function trampoline.
7023
7024@ifclear GENERIC
7025@lowersections
7026@end ifclear
7027@end ifset
7028
36f63dca 7029@node ARM
3674e28a 7030@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7031
7032@cindex ARM interworking support
7033@kindex --support-old-code
7034For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7035between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7036been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7037line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7038libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7039option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7040given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7041which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7042the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7043non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7044
7045@cindex thumb entry point
7046@cindex entry point, thumb
7047@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7048The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7049@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7050But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7051branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7052executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7053
ce11ba6c
KT
7054@cindex PE import table prefixing
7055@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7056The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7057the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7058element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7059import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7060
e489d0ae
PB
7061@cindex BE8
7062@kindex --be8
7063The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7064executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7065objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7066option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7067little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7068
3674e28a
PB
7069@cindex TARGET1
7070@kindex --target1-rel
7071@kindex --target1-abs
7072The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7073@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7074or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7075and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7076
7077@cindex TARGET2
7078@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7079The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7080@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7081meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7082@table @samp
7083@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7084@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7085@item abs
7086@samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
3674e28a
PB
7087@item got-rel
7088@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7089@end table
7090
319850b4
JB
7091@cindex FIX_V4BX
7092@kindex --fix-v4bx
7093The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7094specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7095interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7096also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7097
7098In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7099linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7100@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7101
7102In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7103relocations are ignored.
7104
845b51d6
PB
7105@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7106@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7107Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7108relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7109
7110@smallexample
7111TST rM, #1
7112MOVEQ PC, rM
7113BX Rn
7114@end smallexample
7115
7116This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7117and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7118condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7119
33bfe774
JB
7120@cindex USE_BLX
7121@kindex --use-blx
7122The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7123BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7124situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7125code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7126each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7127
7128This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7129specify it if you are using that target.
7130
c6dd86c6
JB
7131@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7132@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7133The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7134bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7135instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7136to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7137the support code can read the intended values.
7138
7139The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7140intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7141and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7142intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7143full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7144you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7145
7146If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7147enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7148@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7149mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7150vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7151@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7152
7153If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7154potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7155such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7156first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7157instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7158the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7159are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7160
2de70689
MGD
7161@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7162@kindex --fix-arm1176
7163@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7164The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7165in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7166are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7167unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7168
9d5777a3 7169Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7170Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7171http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7172
a504d23a
LA
7173@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7174@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7175
7176The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7177workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7178the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7179off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7180the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7181core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7182integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7183VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7184
7185The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7186necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7187
7188The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7189@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7190STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7191linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7192@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7193
7194If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7195potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7196such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7197replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7198branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7199then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7200
7201The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7202the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7203
7204The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7205they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7206there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7207occurs.
7208
7209The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7210PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7211large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7212cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7213occurs.
7214
bf21ed78
MS
7215@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7216@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7217The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7218warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7219enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7220linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7221using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7222not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7223
7224@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7225@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7226The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7227warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7228@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7229linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7230using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7231
726150b7
NC
7232@cindex PIC_VENEER
7233@kindex --pic-veneer
7234The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7235ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7236is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7237@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7238
7239@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7240@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7241The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7242code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7243perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7244placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7245controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7246The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7247duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7248group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7249code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7250where they should be placed.
7251
7252The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7253@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7254placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7255branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7256placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7257value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7258exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7259A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7260linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7261from the input sections.
7262
7263The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7264@samp{N = +1}.
7265
1a51c1a4
NC
7266Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7267only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7268otherwise.
7269
1db37fe6
YG
7270@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7271@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7272@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7273The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7274
7275The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7276
68fcca92
JW
7277@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7278@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7279@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7280The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7281
7282Please contact ARM for further details.
7283
1db37fe6
YG
7284@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7285@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7286@cindex Merging exidx entries
7287The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7288
7289@kindex --long-plt
7290@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7291The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7292which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7293entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7294
1f56df9d
JW
7295@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7296@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7297The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7298link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7299
4ba2ef8f
TP
7300@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7301All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7302Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7303@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7304veneers in memory.
7305
54ddd295
TP
7306@kindex --cmse-implib
7307@cindex Secure gateway import library
7308The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7309specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7310secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7311executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7312
0955507f
TP
7313@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7314@cindex Input import library
7315The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7316must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7317given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7318in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7319@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7320library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7321library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7322for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7323specified.
7324
36f63dca
NC
7325@ifclear GENERIC
7326@lowersections
7327@end ifclear
7328@end ifset
7329
7330@ifset HPPA
7331@ifclear GENERIC
7332@raisesections
7333@end ifclear
7334
7335@node HPPA ELF32
7336@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7337@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7338@kindex --multi-subspace
7339When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7340import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7341The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7342stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7343multiple sub-spaces.
7344
7345@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7346@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7347Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7348stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7349@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7350sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7351a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7352the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7353conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7354prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7355A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7356branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7357@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7358@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7359detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7360positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7361
7362Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7363single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7364create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7365large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7366
7367@ifclear GENERIC
7368@lowersections
7369@end ifclear
7370@end ifset
7371
7fb9f789
NC
7372@ifset M68K
7373@ifclear GENERIC
7374@raisesections
7375@end ifclear
7376
7377@node M68K
7378@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7379
7380@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7381@kindex --got=@var{type}
7382The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7383The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7384@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7385the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7386@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7387entries only at non-negative offsets.
7388@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7389entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7390support such GOTs.
7391@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7392output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7393file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7394files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7395
7396@ifclear GENERIC
7397@lowersections
7398@end ifclear
7399@end ifset
7400
833794fc
MR
7401@ifset MIPS
7402@ifclear GENERIC
7403@raisesections
7404@end ifclear
7405
7406@node MIPS
7407@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7408
7409@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7410@kindex --insn32
7411@kindex --no-insn32
7412The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7413microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7414in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7415used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7416or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7417including 16-bit ones where possible.
7418
8b10b0b3
MR
7419@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7420@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7421@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7422The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7423control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7424@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7425relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7426calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7427relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7428instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7429or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7430the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7431
833794fc
MR
7432@ifclear GENERIC
7433@lowersections
7434@end ifclear
7435@end ifset
7436
36f63dca
NC
7437@ifset MMIX
7438@ifclear GENERIC
7439@raisesections
7440@end ifclear
7441
7442@node MMIX
7443@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7444For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7445@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7446understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7447can translate between the two formats.
7448
7449There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7450Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7451registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7452equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7453@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7454global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7455this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7456symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7457
7a2de473
HPN
7458Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7459@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7460The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7461of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7462
7463Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7464are left out from an mmo file.
7465
7466@ifclear GENERIC
7467@lowersections
7468@end ifclear
7469@end ifset
7470
7471@ifset MSP430
7472@ifclear GENERIC
7473@raisesections
7474@end ifclear
7475
7476@node MSP430
7477@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7478For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7479will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7480just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7481
7482@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7483The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7484
7485@table @code
7486@item @samp{.vectors}
7487Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7488
7489@item @samp{.bootloader}
7490Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7491in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7492
7493@item @samp{.infomem}
7494Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7495this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7496
c0065db7 7497@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7498This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7499in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7500
7501@item @samp{.noinit}
7502Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7503
c0065db7 7504The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7505@end table
7506
7ef3addb
JL
7507@table @option
7508@cindex MSP430 Options
7509@kindex --code-region
7510@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7511This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7512argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7513using this option.
7514
7515@kindex --data-region
7516@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7517This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7518[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7519for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7520
7521@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7522@item --disable-sec-transformation
7523Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7524and @code{--data-region} options.
7525This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7526wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7527not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7528@end table
7529
36f63dca
NC
7530@ifclear GENERIC
7531@lowersections
7532@end ifclear
7533@end ifset
7534
35c08157
KLC
7535@ifset NDS32
7536@ifclear GENERIC
7537@raisesections
7538@end ifclear
7539
7540@node NDS32
7541@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7542@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7543For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7544relaxes objects according to these options.
7545
7546@table @code
7547@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7548Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7549
7550@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7551Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7552
7553@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7554Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7555
7556@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7557Export the EX9 table after linking.
7558
7559@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7560Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7561
7562@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7563Update the existing EX9 table.
7564
7565@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7566Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7567
7568@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7569Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7570
7571@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7572Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7573
7574@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7575Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7576@end table
7577
7578@ifclear GENERIC
7579@lowersections
7580@end ifclear
7581@end ifset
7582
78058a5e
SL
7583@ifset NIOSII
7584@ifclear GENERIC
7585@raisesections
7586@end ifclear
7587
7588@node Nios II
7589@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7590@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7591@kindex --relax on Nios II
7592
7593Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7594transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7595which may result in @command{ld} giving
7596@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7597The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7598trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7599outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7600trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7601be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7602larger than 256MB.
7603
7604The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7605is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7606@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7607locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7608source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7609register as a temporary.
7610
7611Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7612relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7613option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7614
7615@ifclear GENERIC
7616@lowersections
7617@end ifclear
7618@end ifset
7619
2a60a7a8
AM
7620@ifset POWERPC
7621@ifclear GENERIC
7622@raisesections
7623@end ifclear
7624
7625@node PowerPC ELF32
7626@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7627@cindex PowerPC long branches
7628@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7629Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7630displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7631@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7632@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7633the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7634section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7635section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7636@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7637both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7638considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7639
7640@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7641@table @option
7642@cindex PowerPC PLT
7643@kindex --bss-plt
7644@item --bss-plt
7645Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7646generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7647the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7648writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7649@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7650PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7651compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7652BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7653
016687f8
AM
7654@kindex --secure-plt
7655@item --secure-plt
7656@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7657@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7658when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7659layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7660style BSS PLT.
7661
2a60a7a8
AM
7662@cindex PowerPC GOT
7663@kindex --sdata-got
7664@item --sdata-got
7665The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7666sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7667@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7668section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7669@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7670@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7671@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7672@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7673PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7674pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7675GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7676really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7677
7678@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7679@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7680@item --emit-stub-syms
7681This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7682symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7683
7684@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7685@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7686@item --no-tls-optimize
7687PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7688sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7689disable the optimization.
7690@end table
7691
7692@ifclear GENERIC
7693@lowersections
7694@end ifclear
7695@end ifset
7696
7697@ifset POWERPC64
7698@ifclear GENERIC
7699@raisesections
7700@end ifclear
7701
7702@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7703@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7704
7705@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7706@table @option
7707@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7708@kindex --stub-group-size
7709@item --stub-group-size
7710Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7711by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7712@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7713sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7714a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7715the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7716conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7717prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7718A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7719branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7720@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7721@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7722detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7723positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7724
7725Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7726single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7727create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7728large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7729
7730@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7731@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7732@item --emit-stub-syms
7733This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7734symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7735
7736@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7737@kindex --dotsyms
7738@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
7739@item --dotsyms
7740@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
7741These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7742in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7743function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7744code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7745properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7746to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7747@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7748dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7749feature.
7750
7ae4ea7d
AM
7751@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7752@kindex --save-restore-funcs
7753@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
7754@item --save-restore-funcs
7755@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
7756These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7757provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7758@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7759function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7760link.
7761
2a60a7a8
AM
7762@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7763@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7764@item --no-tls-optimize
7765PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7766sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7767disable the optimization.
7768
7c9cf415
AM
7769@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
7770@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
7771@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
7772@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
7773@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
7774@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
7775@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 7776These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
7777stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
7778an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
7779@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
7780stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
7781generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
7782__tls_get_addr_opt.
7783Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
7784much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
7785an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
7786will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
7787@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
7788and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
7789this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
7790Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 7791@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 7792register saves.
7c9cf415 7793
2a60a7a8
AM
7794@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
7795@kindex --no-opd-optimize
7796@item --no-opd-optimize
7797PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
7798corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 7799the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
7800Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
7801
7802@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
7803@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
7804@item --non-overlapping-opd
7805Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
7806@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
7807the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
7808entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
7809
7810@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
7811@kindex --no-toc-optimize
7812@item --no-toc-optimize
7813PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
7814entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
7815reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
7816marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
7817marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
7818relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
7819unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
7820reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
7821discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
7822reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
7823code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
7824optimization.
7825
7826@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
7827@kindex --no-multi-toc
7828@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
7829If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
7830@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
7831where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
7832entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
7833total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
7834grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
7835TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
7836calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
7837help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
783864K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
7839Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
7840
7841@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
7842@kindex --no-toc-sort
7843@item --no-toc-sort
7844By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
7845happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
7846placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
7847with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
7848referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
7849@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
7850results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
7851off this feature.
7852
7853@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
7854@kindex --plt-align
7855@kindex --no-plt-align
7856@item --plt-align
7857@itemx --no-plt-align
7858Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
7859aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
7860boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
7861specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
7862specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
7863if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
7864PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
7865
7866@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
7867@kindex --plt-static-chain
7868@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
7869@item --plt-static-chain
7870@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
7871Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
7872chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
7873chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
7874
7875@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
7876@kindex --plt-thread-safe
7877@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
7878@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 7879@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
7880With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
7881lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
7882another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
7883order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
7884memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
7885barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
7886looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
7887seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
7888default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
7889
7890@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
7891@kindex --plt-localentry
7892@kindex --no-plt-localentry
7893@item --plt-localentry
7894@itemx --no-localentry
7895ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
7896ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
7897(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
7898Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
7899or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
7900functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
7901in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
7902interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
7903including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
7904to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
7905complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
7906care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
2a60a7a8
AM
7907@end table
7908
7909@ifclear GENERIC
7910@lowersections
7911@end ifclear
7912@end ifset
7913
b4cbbe8f
AK
7914@ifset S/390
7915@ifclear GENERIC
7916@raisesections
7917@end ifclear
7918
7919@node S/390 ELF
7920@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7921
7922@cindex S/390 ELF options
7923@table @option
7924
7925@cindex S/390
7926@kindex --s390-pgste
7927@item --s390-pgste
7928This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
7929segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
7930binaries marked that way.
7931@end table
7932
7933@ifclear GENERIC
7934@lowersections
7935@end ifclear
7936@end ifset
7937
49fa1e15
AM
7938@ifset SPU
7939@ifclear GENERIC
7940@raisesections
7941@end ifclear
7942
7943@node SPU ELF
7944@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7945
7946@cindex SPU ELF options
7947@table @option
7948
7949@cindex SPU plugins
7950@kindex --plugin
7951@item --plugin
7952This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
7953
7954@cindex SPU overlays
7955@kindex --no-overlays
7956@item --no-overlays
7957Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
7958regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
7959@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
7960turns off all this special overlay handling.
7961
7962@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
7963@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7964@item --emit-stub-syms
7965This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
7966symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7967
7968@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
7969@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
7970@item --extra-overlay-stubs
7971This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
7972function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
7973on calls to non-overlay regions.
7974
7975@cindex SPU local store size
7976@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
7977@item --local-store=lo:hi
7978@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
7979the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
7980range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
7981
c0065db7 7982@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
7983@kindex --stack-analysis
7984@item --stack-analysis
7985SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
7986unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
7987under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
7988@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
7989@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
7990determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
7991for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
7992for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
7993for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
7994find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
7995and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
7996under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
7997dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
7998is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
7999and calls will be given.
8000
c0065db7 8001@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8002@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8003@item --emit-stack-syms
8004This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8005in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8006These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8007functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8008functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8009such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8010The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8011@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8012@end table
8013
8014@ifclear GENERIC
8015@lowersections
8016@end ifclear
8017@end ifset
8018
36f63dca
NC
8019@ifset TICOFF
8020@ifclear GENERIC
8021@raisesections
8022@end ifclear
8023
8024@node TI COFF
8025@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8026@cindex TI COFF versions
8027@kindex --format=@var{version}
8028The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8029TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8030also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8031format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8032header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8033
8034@ifclear GENERIC
8035@lowersections
8036@end ifclear
8037@end ifset
8038
2ca22b03
NC
8039@ifset WIN32
8040@ifclear GENERIC
8041@raisesections
8042@end ifclear
8043
8044@node WIN32
8045@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8046
c0065db7 8047This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8048See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8049command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8050
8051@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8052@cindex import libraries
8053@item import libraries
69da35b5 8054The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8055libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8056regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8057archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8058support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8059@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8060
c0065db7
RM
8061@item exporting DLL symbols
8062@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8063The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8064
8065@table @emph
8066@item using auto-export functionality
8067@cindex using auto-export functionality
8068By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8069which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8070
0a5d968e
NC
8071@itemize
8072@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8073@item --exclude-symbols
8074@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8075@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8076@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8077@end itemize
8078
09e2aba4
DK
8079When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8080(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8081symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8082often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8083private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8084options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8085exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8086final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8087
8088If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8089command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8090if either of the following are true:
8091
8092@itemize
8093@item A DEF file is used.
8094@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8095@end itemize
dc8465bf 8096
c0065db7
RM
8097@item using a DEF file
8098@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8099Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8100an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8101exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8102name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8103command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8104
8105@example
8106gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8107@end example
8108
0a5d968e
NC
8109Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8110@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8111
dc8465bf
NC
8112Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8113
8114@example
4b5bd4e7 8115LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8116
8117EXPORTS
8118foo
8119bar
8120_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8121another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8122var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8123doo = foo == foo2
8124eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8125@end example
dc8465bf 8126
7fcab871 8127This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8128symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8129alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8130by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8131@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8132@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8133export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8134in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8135symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8136
6b31ad16
DS
8137The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8138name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8139the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8140
b45619c0
NC
8141When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8142library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8143@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8144executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8145
8146With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8147specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8148non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8149
8150If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8151or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8152filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8153
4b5bd4e7
DS
8154The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8155
8156@example
8157EXPORTS
8158 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8159 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8160 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8161@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8162
8163Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8164@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8165@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8166@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8167Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8168@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8169string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8170
8171The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8172
8173@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8174will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8175by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8176linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8177library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8178
8179@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8180The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8181the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8182@code{*_imp__foo}).
8183
8184@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8185well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8186read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8187variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8188the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8189extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8190application will behave unexpectedly.
8191
8192@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8193it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8194symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8195API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8196the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8197
4b5bd4e7
DS
8198See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8199other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8200
8201@cindex creating a DEF file
8202While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8203with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8204
8205@item Using decorations
8206@cindex Using decorations
8207Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8208itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8209declared as:
8210
8211@example
8212__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8213__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8214@end example
8215
8216All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8217any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8218this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8219the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8220
8221Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8222decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8223instead:
8224
8225@example
8226__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8227__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8228@end example
8229
c0065db7
RM
8230This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8231when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8232variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8233code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8234of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8235omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8236@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8237information.
c0065db7 8238@end table
dc8465bf 8239
2ca22b03
NC
8240@cindex automatic data imports
8241@item automatic data imports
8242The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8243by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8244compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8245issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8246code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8247c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8248initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8249decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8250platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8251command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8252The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8253suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8254trigger the feature's use.
8255
c0065db7 8256auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8257additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8258
c0065db7 8259"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8260documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8261
c0065db7
RM
8262The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8263occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8264One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8265below.
8266
8267@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8268For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8269object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8270offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8271field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8272in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8273without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8274The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8275references.
8276
c0065db7
RM
8277The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8278be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8279themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8280runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8281compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8282support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8283run without error on an older system.
8284
c0065db7
RM
8285@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8286enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8287
8288@cindex direct linking to a dll
8289@item direct linking to a dll
8290The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8291including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8292libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8293traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8294libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8295function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8296though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8297storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8298tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8299large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8300
c0065db7 8301Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8302@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8303of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8304perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8305select the dll instead of an import library.
8306
2ca22b03 8307
69da35b5
NC
8308For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8309to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8310
8311@example
45e948fe
NC
8312libxxx.dll.a
8313xxx.dll.a
8314libxxx.a
8315xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8316libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8317cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8318libxxx.dll
8319xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8320@end example
8321
69da35b5
NC
8322before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8323
c0065db7
RM
8324(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8325where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8326@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8327file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8328@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8329
c0065db7
RM
8330Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8331@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8332was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8333various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8334could coexist on the same machine.
8335
2ca22b03
NC
8336The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8337applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8338libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8339
8340@example
8341bin/
8342 cygxxx.dll
8343lib/
8344 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8345 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8346@end example
8347
c0065db7
RM
8348Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8349done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8350
83511. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8352@example
8353gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8354@end example
2ca22b03 8355
69da35b5
NC
8356However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8357(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8358@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8359not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8360
2ca22b03
NC
83612. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8362directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8363should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8364making the app/dll.
8365
8366@example
8367ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8368@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8369
8370Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8371
8372@example
8373gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8374@end example
69da35b5
NC
8375
8376This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8377perfectly legal
8378
8379@example
8380bin/
8381 cygxxx-5.dll
8382lib/
c0065db7 8383 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8384@end example
8385
dc8465bf 8386Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8387even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8388@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8389
8390Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8391wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8392
83931. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8394work with auto-imported data.
8395
dc8465bf
NC
83962. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8397import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8398symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8399for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8400possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8401
45e948fe
NC
84023. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8403critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8404in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8405stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8406
69da35b5 8407So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8408true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8409a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8410binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8411massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8412requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8413will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8414
c0065db7 8415@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8416@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8417@item adding additional names
8418Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8419A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8420exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8421when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8422import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8423
c0065db7 8424@example
dc8465bf
NC
8425LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8426
8427EXPORTS
c0065db7 8428foo
dc8465bf 8429_foo = foo
c0065db7 8430@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8431
8432The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8433
8434Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8435source code using the "weak" attribute:
8436
c0065db7
RM
8437@example
8438void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8439void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8440@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8441
8442See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8443symbols.
8444
8445@item renaming symbols
8446Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8447kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8448@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8449DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8450created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8451
c0065db7 8452@example
dc8465bf
NC
8453LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8454
8455EXPORTS
8456_foo = foo
c0065db7 8457@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8458
8459The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8460@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8461@end table
dc8465bf 8462
0a5d968e 8463Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8464unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8465If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8466@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8467that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8468@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8469renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8470to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8471the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8472In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8473which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8474
8475@cindex weak externals
8476@item weak externals
8477The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8478weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8479defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8480are three variants of weak externals:
8481@itemize
8482@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8483called lazy externals.
8484@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8485This form is not presently implemented.
8486@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8487implemented.
8488@end itemize
8489As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8490are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8491uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8492
8493@cindex aligned common symbols
8494@item aligned common symbols
8495As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8496desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8497the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8498carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8499by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8500tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8501but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8502warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8503
2ca22b03
NC
8504@end table
8505
8506@ifclear GENERIC
8507@lowersections
8508@end ifclear
8509@end ifset
8510
e0001a05
NC
8511@ifset XTENSA
8512@ifclear GENERIC
8513@raisesections
8514@end ifclear
8515
8516@node Xtensa
8517@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8518
8519@cindex Xtensa processors
8520The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8521@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8522specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8523keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8524example, with the command:
8525
8526@smallexample
8527SECTIONS
8528@{
8529 .text : @{
8530 *(.literal .text)
8531 @}
8532@}
8533@end smallexample
8534
8535@noindent
8536@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8537and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8538literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8539interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8540group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8541files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8542and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8543
43cd72b9 8544@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8545@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8546Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8547provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8548is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8549literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8550will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8551location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8552the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8553unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8554@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8555range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8556
8557For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8558to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8559instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8560instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8561instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8562@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8563hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8564By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8565switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8566density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8567instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8568performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8569linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8570a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8571
8572The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8573control the linker:
8574
8575@cindex Xtensa options
8576@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8577@item --size-opt
8578When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8579more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8580no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8581alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8582preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8583
8584@item --abi-windowed
8585@itemx --abi-call0
8586Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8587PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8588because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8589conventions.
8590Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8591of the first input object.
8592A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8593or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8594@end table
e0001a05
NC
8595
8596@ifclear GENERIC
8597@lowersections
8598@end ifclear
8599@end ifset
8600
252b5132
RH
8601@ifclear SingleFormat
8602@node BFD
8603@chapter BFD
8604
8605@cindex back end
8606@cindex object file management
8607@cindex object formats available
8608@kindex objdump -i
8609The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8610These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8611object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8612format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8613it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8614associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8615object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8616(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8617list all the formats available for your configuration.
8618
8619@cindex BFD requirements
8620@cindex requirements for BFD
8621As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8622several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8623BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8624formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8625been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8626BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8627may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8628
8629One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8630mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8631useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8632conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8633
8634@menu
8635* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8636@end menu
8637
8638@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8639@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8640@cindex opening object files
8641@include bfdsumm.texi
8642@end ifclear
8643
8644@node Reporting Bugs
8645@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8646@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8647@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8648
ff5dcc92 8649Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8650
8651Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8652it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8653to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8654work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8655@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8656
8657In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8658information that enables us to fix the bug.
8659
8660@menu
8661* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8662* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8663@end menu
8664
8665@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8666@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8667@cindex bug criteria
8668
8669If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8670
8671@itemize @bullet
8672@cindex fatal signal
8673@cindex linker crash
8674@cindex crash of linker
8675@item
8676If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8677@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8678
8679@cindex error on valid input
8680@item
ff5dcc92 8681If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8682
8683@cindex invalid input
8684@item
ff5dcc92 8685If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8686may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8687object files are correct.
8688
8689@item
8690If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8691improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8692@end itemize
8693
8694@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8695@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 8696@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 8697@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
8698
8699A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 8700products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
8701recommend you contact that organization first.
8702
8703You can find contact information for many support companies and
8704individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8705distribution.
8706
ad22bfe8 8707@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 8708Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
8709@value{BUGURL}.
8710@end ifset
252b5132
RH
8711
8712The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8713@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8714fact or leave it out, state it!
8715
8716Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8717problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
8718assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8719matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8720the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8721location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8722were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8723into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8724specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 8725and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
8726
8727Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8728the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8729on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
8730
8731Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
8732bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8733respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8734You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
8735
8736To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8737
8738@itemize @bullet
8739@item
ff5dcc92 8740The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
8741the @samp{--version} argument.
8742
8743Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 8744the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8745
8746@item
ff5dcc92 8747Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
8748patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
8749
8750@item
8751The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
8752version number.
8753
8754@item
ff5dcc92 8755What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
8756``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
8757
8758@item
8759The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
8760observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
8761list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
8762sufficient.
8763
8764If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
8765and then we might not encounter the bug.
8766
8767@item
8768A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
8769bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
8770provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
8771bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
8772state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
8773requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
8774we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
8775attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
8776
8777If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
8778@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
8779object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
8780@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
8781how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
8782
8783@item
8784A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
8785incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
8786
ff5dcc92 8787Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
8788will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
8789not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
8790a chance to make a mistake.
8791
8792Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
8793say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 8794copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
8795C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
8796and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
8797fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
8798you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
8799any conclusion from our observations.
8800
8801@item
ff5dcc92 8802If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
8803diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
8804@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 8805If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
8806context, not by line number.
8807
8808The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
8809sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
8810@end itemize
8811
8812Here are some things that are not necessary:
8813
8814@itemize @bullet
8815@item
8816A description of the envelope of the bug.
8817
8818Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
8819which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
8820changes will not affect it.
8821
8822This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
8823will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
8824with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
8825We recommend that you save your time for something else.
8826
8827Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
8828of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
8829output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
8830less time, and so on.
8831
8832However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
8833report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
8834
8835@item
8836A patch for the bug.
8837
8838A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
8839the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
8840a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
8841to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
8842
ff5dcc92 8843Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
8844construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
8845through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
8846able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
8847fixed.
8848
8849And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
8850patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
8851help us to understand.
8852
8853@item
8854A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
8855
8856Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
8857things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
8858@end itemize
8859
8860@node MRI
8861@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
8862@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
8863To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
8864linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
8865alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
8866described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
8867simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 8868@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
8869linker commands; these commands are described here.
8870
8871In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
8872file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
8873features to make use of them.
8874
8875You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
8876@samp{-c} command-line option.
8877
8878Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
8879command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
8880blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 8881MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
8882issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
8883
8884Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
8885
8886You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
8887lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
8888The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
8889
8890@table @code
8891@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
8892@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
8893@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 8894Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
8895the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
8896@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
8897your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
8898script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
8899commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
8900input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
8901@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
8902
8903@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
8904@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
8905Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
8906in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
8907
8908@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
8909
8910@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
8911@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
8912Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
8913@var{expression} should be a power of two.
8914
8915@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
8916@item BASE @var{expression}
8917Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
8918absolute addresses) in the output file.
8919
8920@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
8921@item CHIP @var{expression}
8922@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
8923This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
8924
8925@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
8926@item END
8927This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
8928
8929@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
8930@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
8931Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 8932language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
8933
8934@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
8935@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
8936Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 8937@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
8938
8939The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
8940same line, with no change in its effect.
8941
8942@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
8943@item LOAD @var{filename}
8944@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
8945Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 8946same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
8947command line.
8948
8949@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
8950@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 8951@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
8952MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
8953option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
8954
8955@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
8956@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
8957@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 8958Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
8959order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
8960script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
8961sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
8962file, in the order specified.
8963
8964@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
8965@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
8966@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
8967@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
8968Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
8969@var{name} used in the linker input files.
8970
8971@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
8972@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
8973@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
8974@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
8975You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
8976specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
8977If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
8978@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
8979@end table
8980
793c5807
NC
8981@node GNU Free Documentation License
8982@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 8983@include fdl.texi
704c465c 8984
370b66a1
CD
8985@node LD Index
8986@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
8987
8988@printindex cp
8989
8990@tex
7ca01ed9 8991% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
8992% meantime:
8993\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
8994\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
8995\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
8996\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
8997\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
8998\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
8999\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9000\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9001\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9002% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9003@end tex
9004
252b5132 9005@bye
This page took 1.540458 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.